Fix powerpc-power8.exp test with new mnemonics
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
1 /* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2021 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 #include "defs.h"
21 #include "arch-utils.h"
22 #include <ctype.h>
23 #include "hashtab.h"
24 #include "symtab.h"
25 #include "frame.h"
26 #include "breakpoint.h"
27 #include "tracepoint.h"
28 #include "gdbtypes.h"
29 #include "expression.h"
30 #include "gdbcore.h"
31 #include "gdbcmd.h"
32 #include "value.h"
33 #include "command.h"
34 #include "inferior.h"
35 #include "infrun.h"
36 #include "gdbthread.h"
37 #include "target.h"
38 #include "language.h"
39 #include "gdb-demangle.h"
40 #include "filenames.h"
41 #include "annotate.h"
42 #include "symfile.h"
43 #include "objfiles.h"
44 #include "source.h"
45 #include "linespec.h"
46 #include "completer.h"
47 #include "ui-out.h"
48 #include "cli/cli-script.h"
49 #include "block.h"
50 #include "solib.h"
51 #include "solist.h"
52 #include "observable.h"
53 #include "memattr.h"
54 #include "ada-lang.h"
55 #include "top.h"
56 #include "valprint.h"
57 #include "jit.h"
58 #include "parser-defs.h"
59 #include "gdb_regex.h"
60 #include "probe.h"
61 #include "cli/cli-utils.h"
62 #include "stack.h"
63 #include "ax-gdb.h"
64 #include "dummy-frame.h"
65 #include "interps.h"
66 #include "gdbsupport/format.h"
67 #include "thread-fsm.h"
68 #include "tid-parse.h"
69 #include "cli/cli-style.h"
70
71 /* readline include files */
72 #include "readline/tilde.h"
73
74 /* readline defines this. */
75 #undef savestring
76
77 #include "mi/mi-common.h"
78 #include "extension.h"
79 #include <algorithm>
80 #include "progspace-and-thread.h"
81 #include "gdbsupport/array-view.h"
82 #include "gdbsupport/gdb_optional.h"
83
84 /* Prototypes for local functions. */
85
86 static void map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *,
87 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)>);
88
89 static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
90
91 static void
92 create_sals_from_location_default (struct event_location *location,
93 struct linespec_result *canonical,
94 enum bptype type_wanted);
95
96 static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
97 struct linespec_result *,
98 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
99 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char>,
100 enum bptype,
101 enum bpdisp, int, int,
102 int,
103 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
104 int, int, int, unsigned);
105
106 static std::vector<symtab_and_line> decode_location_default
107 (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
108 struct program_space *search_pspace);
109
110 static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint
111 (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals);
112
113 static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
114
115 static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
116 enum bptype,
117 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
118 static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
119 const struct symtab_and_line *);
120
121 /* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
122 static. */
123 struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
124 struct symtab_and_line,
125 enum bptype,
126 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
127
128 static struct breakpoint *
129 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
130 enum bptype type,
131 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
132 int loc_enabled);
133
134 static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
135
136 static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
137 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
138 enum bptype bptype);
139
140 static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
141 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
142 struct obj_section *, int);
143
144 static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
145 struct bp_location *loc2);
146
147 static int breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
148 struct bp_location *loc2,
149 bool sw_hw_bps_match = false);
150
151 static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
152 const struct address_space *aspace,
153 CORE_ADDR addr);
154
155 static int breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *,
156 const address_space *,
157 CORE_ADDR, int);
158
159 static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *);
160 static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, enum remove_bp_reason);
161
162 static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
163
164 static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
165
166 static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
167
168 static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
169 enum bptype type,
170 int *other_type_used);
171
172 static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
173 int count);
174
175 static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
176
177 static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
178
179 /* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
180 insert locations now. */
181 enum ugll_insert_mode
182 {
183 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
184 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
185 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
186 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
187 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
188 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
189 returns true on them.
190
191 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
192 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
193 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
194 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
195 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
196 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
197 the inferior. */
198 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
199
200 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
201 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
202 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
203
204 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
205 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
206 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
207 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
208 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
209 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
210 as no thread is running yet. */
211 UGLL_INSERT
212 };
213
214 static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
215
216 static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
217
218 static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
219
220 static void trace_pass_command (const char *, int);
221
222 static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
223
224 static bool is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
225
226 /* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
227 otherwise. */
228
229 static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
230
231 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
232 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
233 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
234 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
235
236 /* Internal breakpoints class type. */
237 static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
238
239 /* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
240 static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
241
242 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
243 breakpoints. */
244 struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
245
246 /* Breakpoints set on probes. */
247 static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
248
249 /* Tracepoints set on probes. */
250 static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
251
252 /* Dynamic printf class type. */
253 struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
254
255 /* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
256 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
257 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
258 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
259 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
260 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
261
262 static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
263 static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
264 static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
265 static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
266 dprintf_style_gdb,
267 dprintf_style_call,
268 dprintf_style_agent,
269 NULL
270 };
271 static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
272
273 /* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
274 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
275 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
276 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
277
278 static char *dprintf_function;
279
280 /* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
281 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
282 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
283 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
284 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
285 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
286 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
287
288 static char *dprintf_channel;
289
290 /* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
291 has disconnected. */
292 static bool disconnected_dprintf = true;
293
294 struct command_line *
295 breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
296 {
297 return b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
298 }
299
300 /* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
301 current breakpoint. */
302
303 static bool breakpoint_proceeded;
304
305 const char *
306 bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
307 {
308 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
309 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
310 a breakpoint. */
311 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
312
313 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
314 }
315
316 /* Prototypes for exported functions. */
317 /* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
318 if such is available. */
319 static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
320
321 static void
322 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
323 struct cmd_list_element *c,
324 const char *value)
325 {
326 fprintf_filtered (file,
327 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
328 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
329 value);
330 }
331
332 /* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
333 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
334 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
335 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
336 static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
337 static void
338 show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
339 struct cmd_list_element *c,
340 const char *value)
341 {
342 fprintf_filtered (file,
343 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
344 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
345 value);
346 }
347
348 /* If true, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
349 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
350 If false, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
351 use hardware breakpoints. */
352 static bool automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
353 static void
354 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
355 struct cmd_list_element *c,
356 const char *value)
357 {
358 fprintf_filtered (file,
359 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
360 value);
361 }
362
363 /* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
364 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
365 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
366 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
367 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
368 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
369 processing user input. */
370 static bool always_inserted_mode = false;
371
372 static void
373 show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
374 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
375 {
376 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
377 value);
378 }
379
380 /* See breakpoint.h. */
381
382 int
383 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
384 {
385 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
386 {
387 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
388 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
389 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
390 return 1;
391 }
392 else
393 {
394 if (always_inserted_mode)
395 {
396 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
397 are stopped. */
398 return 1;
399 }
400
401 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
402 if (inf->has_execution ()
403 && threads_are_executing (inf->process_target ()))
404 return 1;
405
406 /* Don't remove breakpoints yet if, even though all threads are
407 stopped, we still have events to process. */
408 for (thread_info *tp : all_non_exited_threads ())
409 if (tp->resumed
410 && tp->suspend.waitstatus_pending_p)
411 return 1;
412 }
413 return 0;
414 }
415
416 static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
417
418 /* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
419 static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
420 static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
421 static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
422 static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
423 condition_evaluation_auto,
424 condition_evaluation_host,
425 condition_evaluation_target,
426 NULL
427 };
428
429 /* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
430 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
431
432 /* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
433 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
434 static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
435
436 /* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
437 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
438 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
439 evaluation mode. */
440
441 static const char *
442 translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
443 {
444 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
445 {
446 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
447 return condition_evaluation_target;
448 else
449 return condition_evaluation_host;
450 }
451 else
452 return mode;
453 }
454
455 /* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
456
457 static const char *
458 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
459 {
460 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
461 }
462
463 /* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
464 otherwise. */
465
466 static int
467 gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
468 {
469 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
470
471 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
472 }
473
474 /* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
475 static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
476
477 /* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
478 static int overlay_events_enabled;
479
480 /* See description in breakpoint.h. */
481 bool target_exact_watchpoints = false;
482
483 /* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
484 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
485 current breakpoint. */
486
487 #define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
488 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
489 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
490 B = TMP)
491
492 /* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
493
494 static struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
495
496 /* See breakpoint.h. */
497
498 breakpoint_range
499 all_breakpoints ()
500 {
501 return breakpoint_range (breakpoint_chain);
502 }
503
504 /* See breakpoint.h. */
505
506 breakpoint_safe_range
507 all_breakpoints_safe ()
508 {
509 return breakpoint_safe_range (all_breakpoints ());
510 }
511
512 /* See breakpoint.h. */
513
514 tracepoint_range
515 all_tracepoints ()
516 {
517 return tracepoint_range (breakpoint_chain);
518 }
519
520 /* Array is sorted by bp_location_is_less_than - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
521
522 static std::vector<bp_location *> bp_locations;
523
524 /* See breakpoint.h. */
525
526 const std::vector<bp_location *> &
527 all_bp_locations ()
528 {
529 return bp_locations;
530 }
531
532 /* Range to iterate over breakpoint locations at a given address. */
533
534 struct bp_locations_at_addr_range
535 {
536 using iterator = std::vector<bp_location *>::iterator;
537
538 bp_locations_at_addr_range (CORE_ADDR addr)
539 {
540 struct compare
541 {
542 bool operator() (const bp_location *loc, CORE_ADDR addr_) const
543 { return loc->address < addr_; }
544
545 bool operator() (CORE_ADDR addr_, const bp_location *loc) const
546 { return addr_ < loc->address; }
547 };
548
549 auto it_pair = std::equal_range (bp_locations.begin (), bp_locations.end (),
550 addr, compare ());
551
552 m_begin = it_pair.first;
553 m_end = it_pair.second;
554 }
555
556 iterator begin () const
557 { return m_begin; }
558
559 iterator end () const
560 { return m_end; }
561
562 private:
563 iterator m_begin;
564 iterator m_end;
565 };
566
567 /* Return a range to iterate over all breakpoint locations exactly at address
568 ADDR.
569
570 If it's needed to iterate multiple times on the same range, it's possible
571 to save the range in a local variable and use it multiple times:
572
573 auto range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (addr);
574
575 for (bp_location *loc : range)
576 // use loc
577
578 for (bp_location *loc : range)
579 // use loc
580
581 This saves a bit of time, as it avoids re-doing the binary searches to find
582 the range's boundaries. Just remember not to change the bp_locations vector
583 in the mean time, as it could make the range's iterators stale. */
584
585 static bp_locations_at_addr_range
586 all_bp_locations_at_addr (CORE_ADDR addr)
587 {
588 return bp_locations_at_addr_range (addr);
589 }
590
591 /* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
592 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid
593 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
594 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to scan for shadow bytes for
595 an address you need to read. */
596
597 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max;
598
599 /* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
600 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
601 BP_LOCATIONS which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
602 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATIONS to
603 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
604
605 static CORE_ADDR bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max;
606
607 /* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
608 from the bp_locations array, but for which a hit may still be
609 reported by a target. */
610 static std::vector<bp_location *> moribund_locations;
611
612 /* Number of last breakpoint made. */
613
614 static int breakpoint_count;
615
616 /* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
617 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
618 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
619 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
620 static int prev_breakpoint_count;
621
622 /* Number of last tracepoint made. */
623
624 static int tracepoint_count;
625
626 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
627 static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
628 struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
629
630 /* See declaration at breakpoint.h. */
631
632 struct breakpoint *
633 breakpoint_find_if (int (*func) (struct breakpoint *b, void *d),
634 void *user_data)
635 {
636 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
637 if (func (b, user_data) != 0)
638 return b;
639
640 return nullptr;
641 }
642
643 /* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
644 static int
645 breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
646 {
647 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
648 }
649
650 /* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
651
652 static void
653 set_breakpoint_count (int num)
654 {
655 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
656 breakpoint_count = num;
657 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
658 }
659
660 /* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
661 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
662 static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
663
664 /* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
665 breakpoint made. */
666
667 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
668 {
669 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
670 }
671
672 /* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
673 breakpoint made. */
674
675 scoped_rbreak_breakpoints::~scoped_rbreak_breakpoints ()
676 {
677 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
678 }
679
680 /* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
681
682 void
683 clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
684 {
685 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
686 b->hit_count = 0;
687 }
688
689 \f
690 /* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
691 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
692
693 struct breakpoint *
694 get_breakpoint (int num)
695 {
696 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
697 if (b->number == num)
698 return b;
699
700 return nullptr;
701 }
702
703 \f
704
705 /* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
706 evaluating conditions on its side. */
707
708 static void
709 mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
710 {
711 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
712 evaluating conditions and if the user has
713 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
714 side. */
715 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
716 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
717 return;
718
719 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
720 return;
721
722 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
723 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
724 }
725
726 /* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
727 evaluating conditions on its side. */
728
729 static void
730 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
731 {
732 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
733 evaluating conditions and if the user has
734 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
735 side. */
736 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
737 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
738
739 return;
740
741 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
742 return;
743
744 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
745 }
746
747 /* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
748 condition_evaluation_mode. */
749
750 static void
751 set_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *args, int from_tty,
752 struct cmd_list_element *c)
753 {
754 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
755
756 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
757 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
758 {
759 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
760 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
761 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
762 return;
763 }
764
765 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
766 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
767
768 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
769 settings was "auto". */
770 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
771
772 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
773 if (new_mode != old_mode)
774 {
775 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
776 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
777
778 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
779 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
780 */
781
782 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
783 {
784 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
785 target. */
786 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
787 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
788 }
789 else
790 {
791 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
792 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
793 target knows about. */
794 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
795 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
796 loc->needs_update = 1;
797 }
798
799 /* Do the update. */
800 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
801 }
802
803 return;
804 }
805
806 /* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
807 what "auto" is translating to. */
808
809 static void
810 show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
811 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
812 {
813 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
814 fprintf_filtered (file,
815 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
816 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
817 value,
818 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
819 else
820 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
821 value);
822 }
823
824 /* Parse COND_STRING in the context of LOC and set as the condition
825 expression of LOC. BP_NUM is the number of LOC's owner, LOC_NUM is
826 the number of LOC within its owner. In case of parsing error, mark
827 LOC as DISABLED_BY_COND. In case of success, unset DISABLED_BY_COND. */
828
829 static void
830 set_breakpoint_location_condition (const char *cond_string, bp_location *loc,
831 int bp_num, int loc_num)
832 {
833 bool has_junk = false;
834 try
835 {
836 expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&cond_string, loc->address,
837 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
838 if (*cond_string != 0)
839 has_junk = true;
840 else
841 {
842 loc->cond = std::move (new_exp);
843 if (loc->disabled_by_cond && loc->enabled)
844 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is now valid at "
845 "location %d, enabling.\n"),
846 bp_num, loc_num);
847
848 loc->disabled_by_cond = false;
849 }
850 }
851 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
852 {
853 if (loc->enabled)
854 {
855 /* Warn if a user-enabled location is now becoming disabled-by-cond.
856 BP_NUM is 0 if the breakpoint is being defined for the first
857 time using the "break ... if ..." command, and non-zero if
858 already defined. */
859 if (bp_num != 0)
860 warning (_("failed to validate condition at location %d.%d, "
861 "disabling:\n %s"), bp_num, loc_num, e.what ());
862 else
863 warning (_("failed to validate condition at location %d, "
864 "disabling:\n %s"), loc_num, e.what ());
865 }
866
867 loc->disabled_by_cond = true;
868 }
869
870 if (has_junk)
871 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), cond_string);
872 }
873
874 void
875 set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, const char *exp,
876 int from_tty, bool force)
877 {
878 if (*exp == 0)
879 {
880 xfree (b->cond_string);
881 b->cond_string = nullptr;
882
883 if (is_watchpoint (b))
884 static_cast<watchpoint *> (b)->cond_exp.reset ();
885 else
886 {
887 int loc_num = 1;
888 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
889 {
890 loc->cond.reset ();
891 if (loc->disabled_by_cond && loc->enabled)
892 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is now valid at "
893 "location %d, enabling.\n"),
894 b->number, loc_num);
895 loc->disabled_by_cond = false;
896 loc_num++;
897
898 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
899 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
900 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
901 }
902 }
903
904 if (from_tty)
905 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
906 }
907 else
908 {
909 if (is_watchpoint (b))
910 {
911 innermost_block_tracker tracker;
912 const char *arg = exp;
913 expression_up new_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker);
914 if (*arg != 0)
915 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
916 watchpoint *w = static_cast<watchpoint *> (b);
917 w->cond_exp = std::move (new_exp);
918 w->cond_exp_valid_block = tracker.block ();
919 }
920 else
921 {
922 /* Parse and set condition expressions. We make two passes.
923 In the first, we parse the condition string to see if it
924 is valid in at least one location. If so, the condition
925 would be accepted. So we go ahead and set the locations'
926 conditions. In case no valid case is found, we throw
927 the error and the condition string will be rejected.
928 This two-pass approach is taken to avoid setting the
929 state of locations in case of a reject. */
930 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
931 {
932 try
933 {
934 const char *arg = exp;
935 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
936 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
937 if (*arg != 0)
938 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
939 break;
940 }
941 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
942 {
943 /* Condition string is invalid. If this happens to
944 be the last loc, abandon (if not forced) or continue
945 (if forced). */
946 if (loc->next == nullptr && !force)
947 throw;
948 }
949 }
950
951 /* If we reach here, the condition is valid at some locations. */
952 int loc_num = 1;
953 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
954 {
955 set_breakpoint_location_condition (exp, loc, b->number, loc_num);
956 loc_num++;
957 }
958 }
959
960 /* We know that the new condition parsed successfully. The
961 condition string of the breakpoint can be safely updated. */
962 xfree (b->cond_string);
963 b->cond_string = xstrdup (exp);
964 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
965 }
966 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
967
968 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
969 }
970
971 /* See breakpoint.h. */
972
973 void
974 set_breakpoint_condition (int bpnum, const char *exp, int from_tty,
975 bool force)
976 {
977 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
978 if (b->number == bpnum)
979 {
980 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
981 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
982 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
983 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
984 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
985
986 if (extlang != NULL)
987 {
988 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
989 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
990 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
991 }
992 set_breakpoint_condition (b, exp, from_tty, force);
993
994 if (is_breakpoint (b))
995 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
996
997 return;
998 }
999
1000 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bpnum);
1001 }
1002
1003 /* The options for the "condition" command. */
1004
1005 struct condition_command_opts
1006 {
1007 /* For "-force". */
1008 bool force_condition = false;
1009 };
1010
1011 static const gdb::option::option_def condition_command_option_defs[] = {
1012
1013 gdb::option::flag_option_def<condition_command_opts> {
1014 "force",
1015 [] (condition_command_opts *opts) { return &opts->force_condition; },
1016 N_("Set the condition even if it is invalid for all current locations."),
1017 },
1018
1019 };
1020
1021 /* Create an option_def_group for the "condition" options, with
1022 CC_OPTS as context. */
1023
1024 static inline gdb::option::option_def_group
1025 make_condition_command_options_def_group (condition_command_opts *cc_opts)
1026 {
1027 return {{condition_command_option_defs}, cc_opts};
1028 }
1029
1030 /* Completion for the "condition" command. */
1031
1032 static void
1033 condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
1034 completion_tracker &tracker,
1035 const char *text, const char * /*word*/)
1036 {
1037 bool has_no_arguments = (*text == '\0');
1038 condition_command_opts cc_opts;
1039 const auto group = make_condition_command_options_def_group (&cc_opts);
1040 if (gdb::option::complete_options
1041 (tracker, &text, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_ERROR, group))
1042 return;
1043
1044 text = skip_spaces (text);
1045 const char *space = skip_to_space (text);
1046 if (*space == '\0')
1047 {
1048 int len;
1049
1050 if (text[0] == '$')
1051 {
1052 tracker.advance_custom_word_point_by (1);
1053 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
1054 if (!isdigit (text[1]))
1055 complete_internalvar (tracker, &text[1]);
1056 return;
1057 }
1058
1059 /* Suggest the "-force" flag if no arguments are given. If
1060 arguments were passed, they either already include the flag,
1061 or we are beyond the point of suggesting it because it's
1062 positionally the first argument. */
1063 if (has_no_arguments)
1064 gdb::option::complete_on_all_options (tracker, group);
1065
1066 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
1067 len = strlen (text);
1068
1069 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
1070 {
1071 char number[50];
1072
1073 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
1074
1075 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
1076 tracker.add_completion (make_unique_xstrdup (number));
1077 }
1078
1079 return;
1080 }
1081
1082 /* We're completing the expression part. Skip the breakpoint num. */
1083 const char *exp_start = skip_spaces (space);
1084 tracker.advance_custom_word_point_by (exp_start - text);
1085 text = exp_start;
1086 const char *word = advance_to_expression_complete_word_point (tracker, text);
1087 expression_completer (cmd, tracker, text, word);
1088 }
1089
1090 /* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
1091
1092 static void
1093 condition_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1094 {
1095 const char *p;
1096 int bnum;
1097
1098 if (arg == 0)
1099 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
1100
1101 p = arg;
1102
1103 /* Check if the "-force" flag was passed. */
1104 condition_command_opts cc_opts;
1105 const auto group = make_condition_command_options_def_group (&cc_opts);
1106 gdb::option::process_options
1107 (&p, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_ERROR, group);
1108
1109 bnum = get_number (&p);
1110 if (bnum == 0)
1111 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
1112
1113 set_breakpoint_condition (bnum, p, from_tty, cc_opts.force_condition);
1114 }
1115
1116 /* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1117 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1118 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1119
1120 static void
1121 check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1122 {
1123 struct command_line *c;
1124
1125 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1126 {
1127 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1128 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1129 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1130
1131 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_0.get ());
1132 check_no_tracepoint_commands (c->body_list_1.get ());
1133
1134 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1135 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1136 command directly. */
1137 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1138 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1139
1140 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1141 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1142 }
1143 }
1144
1145 struct longjmp_breakpoint : public breakpoint
1146 {
1147 ~longjmp_breakpoint () override;
1148 };
1149
1150 /* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1151
1152 static bool
1153 is_tracepoint_type (bptype type)
1154 {
1155 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1156 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1157 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1158 }
1159
1160 static bool
1161 is_longjmp_type (bptype type)
1162 {
1163 return type == bp_longjmp || type == bp_exception;
1164 }
1165
1166 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1167
1168 bool
1169 is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1170 {
1171 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1172 }
1173
1174 /* Factory function to create an appropriate instance of breakpoint given
1175 TYPE. */
1176
1177 static std::unique_ptr<breakpoint>
1178 new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype type)
1179 {
1180 breakpoint *b;
1181
1182 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
1183 b = new tracepoint ();
1184 else if (is_longjmp_type (type))
1185 b = new longjmp_breakpoint ();
1186 else
1187 b = new breakpoint ();
1188
1189 return std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> (b);
1190 }
1191
1192 /* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1193 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1194 found. */
1195
1196 static void
1197 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1198 struct command_line *commands)
1199 {
1200 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1201 {
1202 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1203 struct command_line *c;
1204 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1205
1206 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1207 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1208 ones might not. */
1209 t->step_count = 0;
1210
1211 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1212 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1213 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1214 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1215 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1216 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1217 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1218 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1219 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1220 tracepoint's context. */
1221 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1222 {
1223 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1224 {
1225 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1226 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1227 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1228 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1229 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1230 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1231
1232 if (while_stepping)
1233 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1234 "can be used only once"));
1235 else
1236 while_stepping = c;
1237 }
1238
1239 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1240 }
1241 if (while_stepping)
1242 {
1243 struct command_line *c2;
1244
1245 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_list_1 == nullptr);
1246 c2 = while_stepping->body_list_0.get ();
1247 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1248 {
1249 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1250 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1251 }
1252 }
1253 }
1254 else
1255 {
1256 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1257 }
1258 }
1259
1260 /* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1261 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1262
1263 std::vector<breakpoint *>
1264 static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1265 {
1266 std::vector<breakpoint *> found;
1267
1268 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
1269 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1270 {
1271 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
1272 if (loc->address == addr)
1273 found.push_back (b);
1274 }
1275
1276 return found;
1277 }
1278
1279 /* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1280 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1281
1282 void
1283 breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1284 counted_command_line &&commands)
1285 {
1286 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands.get ());
1287
1288 b->commands = std::move (commands);
1289 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1290 }
1291
1292 /* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1293 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1294 commands. */
1295
1296 void
1297 breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1298 {
1299 int old_silent = b->silent;
1300
1301 b->silent = silent;
1302 if (old_silent != silent)
1303 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1304 }
1305
1306 /* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1307 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1308
1309 void
1310 breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1311 {
1312 int old_thread = b->thread;
1313
1314 b->thread = thread;
1315 if (old_thread != thread)
1316 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1317 }
1318
1319 /* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1320 breakpoint work for any task. */
1321
1322 void
1323 breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1324 {
1325 int old_task = b->task;
1326
1327 b->task = task;
1328 if (old_task != task)
1329 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1330 }
1331
1332 static void
1333 commands_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
1334 struct command_line *control)
1335 {
1336 counted_command_line cmd;
1337 /* cmd_read will be true once we have read cmd. Note that cmd might still be
1338 NULL after the call to read_command_lines if the user provides an empty
1339 list of command by just typing "end". */
1340 bool cmd_read = false;
1341
1342 std::string new_arg;
1343
1344 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1345 {
1346 /* Argument not explicitly given. Synthesize it. */
1347 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1348 new_arg = string_printf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1349 breakpoint_count);
1350 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1351 new_arg = string_printf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1352 }
1353 else
1354 {
1355 /* Create a copy of ARG. This is needed because the "commands"
1356 command may be coming from a script. In that case, the read
1357 line buffer is going to be overwritten in the lambda of
1358 'map_breakpoint_numbers' below when reading the next line
1359 before we are are done parsing the breakpoint numbers. */
1360 new_arg = arg;
1361 }
1362 arg = new_arg.c_str ();
1363
1364 map_breakpoint_numbers
1365 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *b)
1366 {
1367 if (!cmd_read)
1368 {
1369 gdb_assert (cmd == NULL);
1370 if (control != NULL)
1371 cmd = control->body_list_0;
1372 else
1373 {
1374 std::string str
1375 = string_printf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1376 "%s, one per line."),
1377 arg);
1378
1379 auto do_validate = [=] (const char *line)
1380 {
1381 validate_actionline (line, b);
1382 };
1383 gdb::function_view<void (const char *)> validator;
1384 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1385 validator = do_validate;
1386
1387 cmd = read_command_lines (str.c_str (), from_tty, 1, validator);
1388 }
1389 cmd_read = true;
1390 }
1391
1392 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1393 do anything. */
1394 if (b->commands != cmd)
1395 {
1396 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, cmd.get ());
1397 b->commands = cmd;
1398 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
1399 }
1400 });
1401 }
1402
1403 static void
1404 commands_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
1405 {
1406 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1407 }
1408
1409 /* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1410 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1411
1412 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1413 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1414 enum command_control_type
1415 commands_from_control_command (const char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1416 {
1417 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1418 return simple_control;
1419 }
1420
1421 /* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1422
1423 static int
1424 bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1425 {
1426 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1427 return 0;
1428 if (!bl->inserted)
1429 return 0;
1430 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1431 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1432 return 0;
1433 return 1;
1434 }
1435
1436 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1437 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1438 contents.
1439
1440 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1441 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1442 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1443
1444 static void
1445 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1446 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1447 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1448 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1449 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1450 {
1451 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1452 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1453 int bp_size = 0;
1454 int bptoffset = 0;
1455
1456 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1457 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1458 {
1459 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1460 return;
1461 }
1462
1463 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1464 we need to copy. */
1465 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1466 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1467
1468 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1469 {
1470 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1471 reading. */
1472 return;
1473 }
1474
1475 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1476 {
1477 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1478 reading. */
1479 return;
1480 }
1481
1482 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1483 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1484 {
1485 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1486 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1487 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1488 bp_addr = memaddr;
1489 }
1490
1491 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1492 {
1493 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1494 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1495 }
1496
1497 if (readbuf != NULL)
1498 {
1499 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1500 shadow_contents buffer. */
1501 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1502 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1503 + target_info->shadow_len));
1504
1505 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1506 shadow. */
1507 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1508 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1509 }
1510 else
1511 {
1512 const unsigned char *bp;
1513 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1514 int placed_size;
1515
1516 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1517 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1518 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1519
1520 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1521 address. */
1522 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1523
1524 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1525 breakpoint's INSN. */
1526 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1527 }
1528 }
1529
1530 /* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1531 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1532
1533 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1534 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1535 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1536
1537 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1538 bl->address - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1539 up to bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1540 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1541 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1542 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1543 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1544 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
1545 and:
1546 bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1547
1548 void
1549 breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1550 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1551 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1552 {
1553 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1554 search. */
1555 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1556
1557 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1558 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1559 report higher one. */
1560
1561 bc_l = 0;
1562 bc_r = bp_locations.size ();
1563 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1564 {
1565 struct bp_location *bl;
1566
1567 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1568 bl = bp_locations[bc];
1569
1570 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1571 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1572 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1573 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1574
1575 Use the BP_LOCATIONS_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1576 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1577 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1578
1579 if ((bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1580 >= bl->address)
1581 && (bl->address + bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max
1582 <= memaddr))
1583 bc_l = bc;
1584 else
1585 bc_r = bc;
1586 }
1587
1588 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1589 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1590 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1591 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1592 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1593 B:
1594
1595 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1596
1597 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1598 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1599 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1600 and L2. */
1601 while (bc_l > 0
1602 && bp_locations[bc_l]->address == bp_locations[bc_l - 1]->address)
1603 bc_l--;
1604
1605 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1606
1607 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_locations.size (); bc++)
1608 {
1609 struct bp_location *bl = bp_locations[bc];
1610
1611 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1612 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1613 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1614 bl->owner->number);
1615
1616 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1617 content. */
1618
1619 if (bl->address >= bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max
1620 && (memaddr + len
1621 <= (bl->address
1622 - bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)))
1623 break;
1624
1625 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1626 continue;
1627
1628 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1629 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1630 }
1631 }
1632
1633 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1634
1635 bool
1636 is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1637 {
1638 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1639 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1640 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1641 }
1642
1643 /* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1644
1645 static bool
1646 is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1647 {
1648 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1649 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1650 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1651 }
1652
1653 /* See breakpoint.h. */
1654
1655 bool
1656 is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1657 {
1658 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1659 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1660 }
1661
1662 /* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1663 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1664 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1665 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1666 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1667 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1668 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1669 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1670
1671 static int
1672 watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1673 {
1674 return (b->pspace == current_program_space
1675 && (b->watchpoint_thread == null_ptid
1676 || (inferior_ptid == b->watchpoint_thread
1677 && !inferior_thread ()->executing)));
1678 }
1679
1680 /* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1681 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1682
1683 static void
1684 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1685 {
1686 if (w->related_breakpoint != w)
1687 {
1688 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1689 gdb_assert (w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == w);
1690 w->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1691 w->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w->related_breakpoint;
1692 w->related_breakpoint = w;
1693 }
1694 w->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1695 }
1696
1697 /* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1698 watchpoint W. */
1699
1700 static struct value *
1701 extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1702 {
1703 struct value *bit_val;
1704
1705 if (val == NULL)
1706 return NULL;
1707
1708 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1709
1710 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1711 w->val_bitpos,
1712 w->val_bitsize,
1713 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1714 value_offset (val),
1715 val);
1716
1717 return bit_val;
1718 }
1719
1720 /* Allocate a dummy location and add it to B, which must be a software
1721 watchpoint. This is required because even if a software watchpoint
1722 is not watching any memory, bpstat_stop_status requires a location
1723 to be able to report stops. */
1724
1725 static void
1726 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (struct breakpoint *b,
1727 struct program_space *pspace)
1728 {
1729 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL);
1730
1731 b->loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1732 b->loc->pspace = pspace;
1733 b->loc->address = -1;
1734 b->loc->length = -1;
1735 }
1736
1737 /* Returns true if B is a software watchpoint that is not watching any
1738 memory (e.g., "watch $pc"). */
1739
1740 static bool
1741 is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
1742 {
1743 return (b->type == bp_watchpoint
1744 && b->loc != NULL
1745 && b->loc->next == NULL
1746 && b->loc->address == -1
1747 && b->loc->length == -1);
1748 }
1749
1750 /* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1751 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1752 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1753 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1754 in b->loc->cond.
1755 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1756
1757 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1758 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1759 it.
1760
1761 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1762 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1763 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1764 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1765 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1766 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1767 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1768 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1769
1770 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1771 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1772 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1773 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1774 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1775 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1776 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1777 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1778 not changed.
1779
1780 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1781 hardware watchpoints:
1782
1783 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1784 called several times when GDB stops.
1785
1786 [linux]
1787 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1788 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1789 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1790 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1791 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1792 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1793 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1794 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1795 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1796 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1797 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1798
1799 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1800 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1801
1802 static void
1803 update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1804 {
1805 int within_current_scope;
1806 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1807 int frame_saved;
1808
1809 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1810 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1811 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1812 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1813 return;
1814
1815 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1816 return;
1817
1818 frame_saved = 0;
1819
1820 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1821 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1822 within_current_scope = 1;
1823 else
1824 {
1825 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1826 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1827 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1828
1829 /* If we're at a point where the stack has been destroyed
1830 (e.g. in a function epilogue), unwinding may not work
1831 properly. Do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1832 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1833 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1834 return;
1835
1836 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1837 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1838 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1839 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1840 selected frame. */
1841 frame_saved = 1;
1842 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1843
1844 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1845 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1846 if (within_current_scope)
1847 select_frame (fi);
1848 }
1849
1850 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1851 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1852 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1853 b->loc = NULL;
1854
1855 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1856 {
1857 const char *s;
1858
1859 b->exp.reset ();
1860 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1861 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1862 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1863 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1864 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1865 be completely different objects. */
1866 b->val = NULL;
1867 b->val_valid = false;
1868
1869 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1870 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1871 locations (re)created below. */
1872 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
1873 {
1874 b->cond_exp.reset ();
1875
1876 s = b->cond_string;
1877 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1878 }
1879 }
1880
1881 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1882 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1883 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1884 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1885 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1886 if (!target_has_execution ())
1887 {
1888 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1889 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1890 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1891 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1892 {
1893 if (b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
1894 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
1895 else
1896 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1897 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1898 }
1899 }
1900 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1901 {
1902 std::vector<value_ref_ptr> val_chain;
1903 struct value *v, *result;
1904 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1905
1906 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), b->exp->op.get (), &v, &result,
1907 &val_chain, false);
1908
1909 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1910 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1911 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1912 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1913 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1914 watchpoints. */
1915 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (b))
1916 {
1917 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1918 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1919 b->val = release_value (v);
1920 b->val_valid = true;
1921 }
1922
1923 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1924
1925 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1926 gdb_assert (!val_chain.empty ());
1927 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : val_chain)
1928 {
1929 v = iter.get ();
1930
1931 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1932 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1933 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1934 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1935 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1936 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1937 && (v == val_chain[0] || ! value_lazy (v)))
1938 {
1939 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1940
1941 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1942 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1943 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1944 if (v == result
1945 || (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1946 && vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1947 {
1948 CORE_ADDR addr;
1949 enum target_hw_bp_type type;
1950 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1951 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1952
1953 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1954 {
1955 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1956 sub-expression. */
1957 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1958 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1959 }
1960 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1961 {
1962 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1963 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1964 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1965 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1966 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1967 }
1968
1969 addr = value_address (v);
1970 if (bitsize != 0)
1971 {
1972 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1973 addr += bitpos / 8;
1974 }
1975
1976 type = hw_write;
1977 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1978 type = hw_read;
1979 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1980 type = hw_access;
1981
1982 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
1983 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1984 ;
1985 *tmp = loc;
1986 loc->gdbarch = value_type (v)->arch ();
1987
1988 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1989 loc->address = address_significant (loc->gdbarch, addr);
1990
1991 if (bitsize != 0)
1992 {
1993 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
1994 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
1995 }
1996 else
1997 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
1998
1999 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
2000 }
2001 }
2002 }
2003
2004 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
2005 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
2006 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
2007 is started. */
2008 if (reparse)
2009 {
2010 int reg_cnt;
2011 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
2012
2013 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
2014
2015 if (reg_cnt)
2016 {
2017 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
2018 enum bptype type;
2019
2020 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
2021 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
2022 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
2023
2024 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
2025 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
2026 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
2027 this watchpoint in as well. */
2028
2029 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
2030 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
2031 hardware watchpoint type. */
2032 type = b->type;
2033 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
2034 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
2035
2036 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
2037 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
2038 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
2039 through watch_command), so always account for it
2040 manually. */
2041
2042 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
2043 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (b, type, &other_type_used);
2044
2045 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
2046 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
2047
2048 target_resources_ok
2049 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
2050 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
2051 {
2052 int sw_mode = b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b);
2053
2054 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
2055 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
2056 "hardware watchpoint."));
2057 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
2058 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
2059 "resources for this watchpoint."));
2060
2061 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
2062 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
2063 }
2064 else
2065 {
2066 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
2067 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
2068 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
2069 nop. */
2070 b->type = type;
2071 }
2072 }
2073 else if (!b->ops->works_in_software_mode (b))
2074 {
2075 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
2076 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
2077 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
2078 else
2079 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
2080 "read/access watchpoint."));
2081 }
2082 else
2083 b->type = bp_watchpoint;
2084
2085 loc_type = (b->type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
2086 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
2087 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
2088 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
2089 }
2090
2091 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
2092 above left it without any location set up. But,
2093 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
2094 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
2095 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc == NULL)
2096 software_watchpoint_add_no_memory_location (b, frame_pspace);
2097 }
2098 else if (!within_current_scope)
2099 {
2100 printf_filtered (_("\
2101 Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
2102 in which its expression is valid.\n"),
2103 b->number);
2104 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
2105 }
2106
2107 /* Restore the selected frame. */
2108 if (frame_saved)
2109 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
2110 }
2111
2112
2113 /* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
2114 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
2115 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
2116 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
2117 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
2118 static int
2119 should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2120 {
2121 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2122 return 0;
2123
2124 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2125 return 0;
2126
2127 if (!bl->enabled || bl->disabled_by_cond
2128 || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2129 return 0;
2130
2131 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2132 return 0;
2133
2134 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2135 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2136 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2137 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2138 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2139 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2140 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2141 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2142 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2143 return 0;
2144
2145 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2146 location, except if the breakpoint is a single-step breakpoint,
2147 and the breakpoint's thread is the thread which is stepping past
2148 a breakpoint. */
2149 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2150 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2151 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2152 bl->address)
2153 /* The single-step breakpoint may be inserted at the location
2154 we're trying to step if the instruction branches to itself.
2155 However, the instruction won't be executed at all and it may
2156 break the semantics of the instruction, for example, the
2157 instruction is a conditional branch or updates some flags.
2158 We can't fix it unless GDB is able to emulate the instruction
2159 or switch to displaced stepping. */
2160 && !(bl->owner->type == bp_single_step
2161 && thread_is_stepping_over_breakpoint (bl->owner->thread)))
2162 {
2163 infrun_debug_printf ("skipping breakpoint: stepping past insn at: %s",
2164 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2165 return 0;
2166 }
2167
2168 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2169 instruction that triggered one. */
2170 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2171 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2172 {
2173 infrun_debug_printf ("stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2174 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d",
2175 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address), bl->length);
2176 return 0;
2177 }
2178
2179 return 1;
2180 }
2181
2182 /* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2183 that the location is not duplicated. */
2184
2185 static int
2186 unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2187 {
2188 int result;
2189 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2190
2191 bl->duplicate = 0;
2192 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2193 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2194 return result;
2195 }
2196
2197 /* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2198 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2199 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2200 any error during parsing. */
2201
2202 static agent_expr_up
2203 parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2204 {
2205 if (cond == NULL)
2206 return NULL;
2207
2208 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2209
2210 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2211 that may show up. */
2212 try
2213 {
2214 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2215 }
2216
2217 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
2218 {
2219 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2220 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2221 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2222 }
2223
2224 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2225 return aexpr;
2226 }
2227
2228 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2229 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2230 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2231 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2232 one of them is true. */
2233
2234 static void
2235 build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2236 {
2237 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2238 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2239
2240 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2241 bl->target_info.conditions.clear ();
2242
2243 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2244 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2245 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2246 side. */
2247 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2248 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2249 return;
2250
2251 auto loc_range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (bl->address);
2252
2253 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2254 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent
2255 expression bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to
2256 send conditions to the target since this location will always
2257 trigger and generate a response back to GDB. Note we consider
2258 all locations at the same address irrespective of type, i.e.,
2259 even if the locations aren't considered duplicates (e.g.,
2260 software breakpoint and hardware breakpoint at the same
2261 address). */
2262 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2263 {
2264 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2265 {
2266 if (modified)
2267 {
2268 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2269 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2270 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2271 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2272 loc->cond_bytecode = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2273 loc->cond.get ());
2274 }
2275
2276 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2277 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2278 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2279 {
2280 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2281 break;
2282 }
2283 }
2284 }
2285
2286 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2287 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2288 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2289
2290 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2291 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2292 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2293 {
2294 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2295 {
2296 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2297 {
2298 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2299 located. */
2300 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2301 return;
2302
2303 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
2304 }
2305 }
2306 }
2307
2308 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a
2309 condition list for this location's address. If we have software
2310 and hardware locations at the same address, they aren't
2311 considered duplicates, but we still marge all the conditions
2312 anyway, as it's simpler, and doesn't really make a practical
2313 difference. */
2314 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2315 if (loc->cond
2316 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2317 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2318 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2319 && loc->enabled
2320 && !loc->disabled_by_cond)
2321 {
2322 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later
2323 to send the conditions to the target. */
2324 bl->target_info.conditions.push_back (loc->cond_bytecode.get ());
2325 }
2326
2327 return;
2328 }
2329
2330 /* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2331 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2332 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2333
2334 static agent_expr_up
2335 parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2336 {
2337 const char *cmdrest;
2338 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2339 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2340
2341 if (cmd == NULL)
2342 return NULL;
2343
2344 cmdrest = cmd;
2345
2346 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2347 ++cmdrest;
2348 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2349
2350 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2351 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2352
2353 format_start = cmdrest;
2354
2355 format_pieces fpieces (&cmdrest);
2356
2357 format_end = cmdrest;
2358
2359 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2360 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2361
2362 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2363
2364 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2365 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2366
2367 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2368 cmdrest++;
2369 cmdrest = skip_spaces (cmdrest);
2370
2371 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2372
2373 std::vector<struct expression *> argvec;
2374 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2375 {
2376 const char *cmd1;
2377
2378 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2379 expression_up expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2380 argvec.push_back (expr.release ());
2381 cmdrest = cmd1;
2382 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2383 ++cmdrest;
2384 }
2385
2386 agent_expr_up aexpr;
2387
2388 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2389 that may show up. */
2390 try
2391 {
2392 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2393 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2394 argvec.size (), argvec.data ());
2395 }
2396 catch (const gdb_exception_error &ex)
2397 {
2398 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2399 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2400 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2401 }
2402
2403 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2404 return aexpr;
2405 }
2406
2407 /* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2408 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2409 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2410
2411 static void
2412 build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2413 {
2414 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2415 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2416
2417 /* Clear commands left over from a previous insert. */
2418 bl->target_info.tcommands.clear ();
2419
2420 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2421 return;
2422
2423 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2424 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2425 return;
2426
2427 auto loc_range = all_bp_locations_at_addr (bl->address);
2428
2429 /* For now, if we have any location at the same address that isn't a
2430 dprintf, don't install the target-side commands, as that would
2431 make the breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2432 control. */
2433 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2434 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2435 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2436 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2437 return;
2438
2439 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2440 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2441 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2442 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2443 response back to GDB. */
2444 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2445 {
2446 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2447 {
2448 if (modified)
2449 {
2450 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2451 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2452 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2453 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2454 loc->cmd_bytecode
2455 = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2456 loc->owner->extra_string);
2457 }
2458
2459 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2460 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2461 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2462 {
2463 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2464 break;
2465 }
2466 }
2467 }
2468
2469 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2470 and so clean up. */
2471 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2472 {
2473 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2474 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2475 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2476 {
2477 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2478 located. */
2479 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2480 return;
2481
2482 loc->cmd_bytecode.reset ();
2483 }
2484 }
2485
2486 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command
2487 list for all duplicate locations at this location's address.
2488 Note that here we must care for whether the breakpoint location
2489 types are considered duplicates, otherwise, say, if we have a
2490 software and hardware location at the same address, the target
2491 could end up running the commands twice. For the moment, we only
2492 support targets-side commands with dprintf, but it doesn't hurt
2493 to be pedantically correct in case that changes. */
2494 for (bp_location *loc : loc_range)
2495 if (breakpoint_locations_match (bl, loc)
2496 && loc->owner->extra_string
2497 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2498 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2499 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2500 && loc->enabled
2501 && !loc->disabled_by_cond)
2502 {
2503 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2504 to send the commands to the target. */
2505 bl->target_info.tcommands.push_back (loc->cmd_bytecode.get ());
2506 }
2507
2508 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2509 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2510 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2511 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2512 }
2513
2514 /* Return the kind of breakpoint on address *ADDR. Get the kind
2515 of breakpoint according to ADDR except single-step breakpoint.
2516 Get the kind of single-step breakpoint according to the current
2517 registers state. */
2518
2519 static int
2520 breakpoint_kind (struct bp_location *bl, CORE_ADDR *addr)
2521 {
2522 if (bl->owner->type == bp_single_step)
2523 {
2524 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (bl->owner->thread);
2525 struct regcache *regcache;
2526
2527 regcache = get_thread_regcache (thr);
2528
2529 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_current_state (bl->gdbarch,
2530 regcache, addr);
2531 }
2532 else
2533 return gdbarch_breakpoint_kind_from_pc (bl->gdbarch, addr);
2534 }
2535
2536 /* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2537 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2538 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2539 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2540 -1 for failure.
2541
2542 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2543 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2544 static int
2545 insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2546 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2547 int *disabled_breaks,
2548 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2549 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2550 {
2551 gdb_exception bp_excpt;
2552
2553 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2554 return 0;
2555
2556 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2557 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2558 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2559 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2560 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2561 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2562 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2563 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2564 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2565 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2566 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2567 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2568
2569 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2570 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2571 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2572 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2573
2574 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2575 {
2576 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2577 build_target_command_list (bl);
2578 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2579 bl->needs_update = 0;
2580 }
2581
2582 /* If "set breakpoint auto-hw" is "on" and a software breakpoint was
2583 set at a read-only address, then a breakpoint location will have
2584 been changed to hardware breakpoint before we get here. If it is
2585 "off" however, error out before actually trying to insert the
2586 breakpoint, with a nicer error message. */
2587 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2588 && !automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2589 {
2590 mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address);
2591
2592 if (mr != nullptr && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2593 {
2594 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2595 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2596 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2597 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2598 bl->owner->number,
2599 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2600 return 1;
2601 }
2602 }
2603
2604 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2605 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2606 {
2607 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2608 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2609 || bl->section == NULL
2610 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2611 {
2612 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2613 try
2614 {
2615 int val;
2616
2617 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2618 if (val)
2619 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2620 }
2621 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2622 {
2623 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2624 }
2625 }
2626 else
2627 {
2628 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2629 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2630 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2631 {
2632 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2633 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2634 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2635 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2636 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2637 bl->owner->number);
2638 else
2639 {
2640 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2641 bl->section);
2642 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2643 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2644 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2645
2646 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2647 try
2648 {
2649 int val;
2650
2651 bl->overlay_target_info.kind
2652 = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
2653 bl->overlay_target_info.placed_address = addr;
2654 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2655 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2656 if (val)
2657 bp_excpt
2658 = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2659 }
2660 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2661 {
2662 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2663 }
2664
2665 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2666 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2667 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2668 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2669 bl->owner->number);
2670 }
2671 }
2672 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2673 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2674 {
2675 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2676 try
2677 {
2678 int val;
2679
2680 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2681 if (val)
2682 bp_excpt = gdb_exception {RETURN_ERROR, GENERIC_ERROR};
2683 }
2684 catch (gdb_exception &e)
2685 {
2686 bp_excpt = std::move (e);
2687 }
2688 }
2689 else
2690 {
2691 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2692 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2693 return 0;
2694 }
2695 }
2696
2697 if (bp_excpt.reason != 0)
2698 {
2699 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2700
2701 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2702 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2703 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2704 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2705 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2706 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2707 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2708 errors as memory errors. */
2709 if (bp_excpt.reason == RETURN_ERROR
2710 && (bp_excpt.error == GENERIC_ERROR
2711 || bp_excpt.error == MEMORY_ERROR)
2712 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2713 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2714 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2715 bl->address)))
2716 {
2717 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2718 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2719 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bl->owner);
2720 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2721 {
2722 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2723 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2724 bl->owner->number);
2725 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2726 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2727 "library breakpoints:\n");
2728 }
2729 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2730 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2731 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2732 return 0;
2733 }
2734 else
2735 {
2736 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2737 {
2738 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2739 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_excpt.message != NULL;
2740 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2741 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2742 bl->owner->number,
2743 bp_excpt.message ? ":" : ".\n");
2744 if (bp_excpt.message != NULL)
2745 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n",
2746 bp_excpt.what ());
2747 }
2748 else
2749 {
2750 if (bp_excpt.message == NULL)
2751 {
2752 std::string message
2753 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2754 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2755
2756 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2757 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2758 "%s\n",
2759 bl->owner->number, message.c_str ());
2760 }
2761 else
2762 {
2763 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2764 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2765 bl->owner->number,
2766 bp_excpt.what ());
2767 }
2768 }
2769 return 1;
2770
2771 }
2772 }
2773 else
2774 bl->inserted = 1;
2775
2776 return 0;
2777 }
2778
2779 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2780 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2781 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2782 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2783 {
2784 int val;
2785
2786 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2787 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2788
2789 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2790
2791 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2792 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2793 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2794 {
2795 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2796 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2797 of this one. */
2798 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
2799 if (loc != bl
2800 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2801 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2802 {
2803 bl->duplicate = 1;
2804 bl->inserted = 1;
2805 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2806 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2807 val = 0;
2808 break;
2809 }
2810
2811 if (val == 1)
2812 {
2813 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2814 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2815
2816 if (val)
2817 /* Back to the original value. */
2818 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2819 }
2820 }
2821
2822 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2823 }
2824
2825 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2826 {
2827 int val;
2828
2829 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2830 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2831
2832 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2833 if (val)
2834 {
2835 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2836
2837 if (val == 1)
2838 warning (_("\
2839 Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2840 of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2841 else
2842 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2843 }
2844
2845 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2846
2847 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2848 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2849 so just return success. */
2850 return 0;
2851 }
2852
2853 return 0;
2854 }
2855
2856 /* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2857 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2858 PSPACE anymore. */
2859
2860 void
2861 breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2862 {
2863 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2864 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
2865 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2866 delete_breakpoint (b);
2867
2868 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2869 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2870 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
2871 {
2872 struct bp_location *tmp;
2873
2874 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2875 {
2876 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2877 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2878 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2879 else
2880 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2881 if (tmp->next == loc)
2882 {
2883 tmp->next = loc->next;
2884 break;
2885 }
2886 }
2887 }
2888
2889 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2890 removed locations above. */
2891 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2892 }
2893
2894 /* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2895 Throws exception on any error.
2896 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2897 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2898 void
2899 insert_breakpoints (void)
2900 {
2901 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
2902 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2903 {
2904 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2905
2906 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2907 }
2908
2909 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2910 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2911 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. Also,
2912 update_global_location_list tries to "upgrade" software
2913 breakpoints to hardware breakpoints to handle "set breakpoint
2914 auto-hw", so we need to call it even if we don't have new
2915 locations. */
2916 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
2917 }
2918
2919 /* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
2920 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
2921 always-inserted mode. */
2922
2923 static void
2924 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
2925 {
2926 int error_flag = 0;
2927 int val = 0;
2928 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2929 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2930 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
2931
2932 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2933
2934 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2935 there was an error. */
2936 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2937
2938 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2939
2940 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
2941 {
2942 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
2943 breakpoints. */
2944 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2945 continue;
2946
2947 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
2948 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
2949 deletion of breakpoints. */
2950 if (!bl->inserted || !bl->needs_update)
2951 continue;
2952
2953 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
2954
2955 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
2956 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
2957 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
2958 insert breakpoints. */
2959 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
2960 && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ()))
2961 continue;
2962
2963 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
2964 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
2965 if (val)
2966 error_flag = val;
2967 }
2968
2969 if (error_flag)
2970 {
2971 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
2972 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
2973 }
2974 }
2975
2976 /* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
2977
2978 static void
2979 insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
2980 {
2981 int error_flag = 0;
2982 int val = 0;
2983 int disabled_breaks = 0;
2984 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
2985 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
2986
2987 string_file tmp_error_stream;
2988
2989 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
2990 there was an error. */
2991 tmp_error_stream.puts ("Warning:\n");
2992
2993 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
2994
2995 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
2996 {
2997 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2998 continue;
2999
3000 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
3001 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
3002 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3003 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
3004 && !valid_global_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
3005 continue;
3006
3007 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3008
3009 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3010 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3011 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3012 insert breakpoints. */
3013 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3014 && (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ()))
3015 continue;
3016
3017 val = insert_bp_location (bl, &tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3018 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
3019 if (val)
3020 error_flag = val;
3021 }
3022
3023 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
3024 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
3025 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
3026 {
3027 int some_failed = 0;
3028
3029 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3030 continue;
3031
3032 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
3033 continue;
3034
3035 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
3036 continue;
3037
3038 for (bp_location *loc : bpt->locations ())
3039 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
3040 {
3041 some_failed = 1;
3042 break;
3043 }
3044
3045 if (some_failed)
3046 {
3047 for (bp_location *loc : bpt->locations ())
3048 if (loc->inserted)
3049 remove_breakpoint (loc);
3050
3051 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3052 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert "
3053 "hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3054 bpt->number);
3055 error_flag = -1;
3056 }
3057 }
3058
3059 if (error_flag)
3060 {
3061 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3062 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3063 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3064 {
3065 tmp_error_stream.printf ("Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3066 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3067 }
3068 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
3069 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3070 }
3071 }
3072
3073 /* Used when the program stops.
3074 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3075 removing a breakpoint location. */
3076
3077 int
3078 remove_breakpoints (void)
3079 {
3080 int val = 0;
3081
3082 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3083 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3084 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl);
3085
3086 return val;
3087 }
3088
3089 /* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3090 that thread. */
3091
3092 static void
3093 remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3094 {
3095 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
3096 {
3097 if (b->thread == tp->global_num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3098 {
3099 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3100
3101 printf_filtered (_("\
3102 Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %s no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3103 b->number, print_thread_id (tp));
3104
3105 /* Hide it from the user. */
3106 b->number = 0;
3107 }
3108 }
3109 }
3110
3111 /* See breakpoint.h. */
3112
3113 void
3114 remove_breakpoints_inf (inferior *inf)
3115 {
3116 int val;
3117
3118 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3119 {
3120 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3121 continue;
3122
3123 if (bl->inserted && !bl->target_info.persist)
3124 {
3125 val = remove_breakpoint (bl);
3126 if (val != 0)
3127 return;
3128 }
3129 }
3130 }
3131
3132 static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3133
3134 /* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3135 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3136 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3137 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3138 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3139 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3140 static void
3141 set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3142 {
3143 if (internal)
3144 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3145 else
3146 {
3147 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3148 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3149 }
3150 }
3151
3152 static struct breakpoint *
3153 create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3154 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3155 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3156 {
3157 symtab_and_line sal;
3158 sal.pc = address;
3159 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3160 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3161
3162 breakpoint *b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3163 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3164 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3165
3166 return b;
3167 }
3168
3169 static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3170 {
3171 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3172 };
3173 #define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3174
3175 /* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3176 struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3177 {
3178 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3179 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym {};
3180
3181 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3182 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES] {};
3183
3184 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3185 int longjmp_searched = 0;
3186
3187 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). These are non-owning
3188 references. */
3189 std::vector<probe *> longjmp_probes;
3190
3191 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3192 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym {};
3193
3194 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3195 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym {};
3196
3197 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3198 int exception_searched = 0;
3199
3200 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). These are non-owning
3201 references. */
3202 std::vector<probe *> exception_probes;
3203 };
3204
3205 static const struct objfile_key<breakpoint_objfile_data>
3206 breakpoint_objfile_key;
3207
3208 /* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3209 static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3210
3211 /* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3212
3213 static int
3214 msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3215 {
3216 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3217 }
3218
3219 /* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3220 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3221
3222 static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3223 get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3224 {
3225 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3226
3227 bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.get (objfile);
3228 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3229 bp_objfile_data = breakpoint_objfile_key.emplace (objfile);
3230 return bp_objfile_data;
3231 }
3232
3233 static void
3234 create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3235 {
3236 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3237
3238 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3239 {
3240 struct breakpoint *b;
3241 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3242 CORE_ADDR addr;
3243 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3244
3245 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3246
3247 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3248 continue;
3249
3250 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3251 {
3252 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3253
3254 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3255 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3256 {
3257 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3258 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3259 continue;
3260 }
3261 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3262 }
3263
3264 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3265 b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile->arch (), addr,
3266 bp_overlay_event,
3267 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3268 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3269 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3270 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3271
3272 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3273 {
3274 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3275 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3276 }
3277 else
3278 {
3279 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3280 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3281 }
3282 }
3283 }
3284
3285 /* Install a master longjmp breakpoint for OBJFILE using a probe. Return
3286 true if a breakpoint was installed. */
3287
3288 static bool
3289 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_probe (objfile *objfile)
3290 {
3291 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
3292 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3293 = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3294
3295 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3296 {
3297 std::vector<probe *> ret
3298 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3299
3300 if (!ret.empty ())
3301 {
3302 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3303 probe *p = ret[0];
3304
3305 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3306 {
3307 /* We cannot use the probe interface here,
3308 because it does not know how to evaluate
3309 arguments. */
3310 ret.clear ();
3311 }
3312 }
3313 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3314 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3315 }
3316
3317 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes.empty ())
3318 return false;
3319
3320 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes)
3321 {
3322 struct breakpoint *b;
3323
3324 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3325 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3326 bp_longjmp_master,
3327 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3328 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3329 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3330 }
3331
3332 return true;
3333 }
3334
3335 /* Install master longjmp breakpoints for OBJFILE using longjmp_names.
3336 Return true if at least one breakpoint was installed. */
3337
3338 static bool
3339 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_names (objfile *objfile)
3340 {
3341 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
3342 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3343 return false;
3344
3345 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data
3346 = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3347 unsigned int installed_bp = 0;
3348
3349 for (int i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3350 {
3351 struct breakpoint *b;
3352 const char *func_name;
3353 CORE_ADDR addr;
3354 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3355
3356 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3357 continue;
3358
3359 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3360 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3361 {
3362 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3363
3364 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3365 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3366 {
3367 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3368 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3369 continue;
3370 }
3371 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3372 }
3373
3374 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3375 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3376 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3377 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3378 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3379 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3380 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3381 installed_bp++;
3382 }
3383
3384 return installed_bp > 0;
3385 }
3386
3387 /* Create a master longjmp breakpoint. */
3388
3389 static void
3390 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3391 {
3392 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3393
3394 for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces)
3395 {
3396 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3397
3398 for (objfile *obj : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3399 {
3400 /* Skip separate debug object, it's handled in the loop below. */
3401 if (obj->separate_debug_objfile_backlink != nullptr)
3402 continue;
3403
3404 /* Try a probe kind breakpoint on main objfile. */
3405 if (create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_probe (obj))
3406 continue;
3407
3408 /* Try longjmp_names kind breakpoints on main and separate_debug
3409 objfiles. */
3410 for (objfile *debug_objfile : obj->separate_debug_objfiles ())
3411 if (create_longjmp_master_breakpoint_names (debug_objfile))
3412 break;
3413 }
3414 }
3415 }
3416
3417 /* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3418 static void
3419 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3420 {
3421 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3422
3423 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
3424
3425 for (struct program_space *pspace : program_spaces)
3426 {
3427 CORE_ADDR addr;
3428
3429 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3430
3431 for (objfile *objfile : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3432 {
3433 struct breakpoint *b;
3434 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3435 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3436
3437 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3438
3439 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3440 continue;
3441
3442 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3443 {
3444 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3445
3446 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3447 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3448 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3449 {
3450 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3451 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3452 continue;
3453 }
3454 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3455 }
3456
3457 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3458 b = create_internal_breakpoint (objfile->arch (), addr,
3459 bp_std_terminate_master,
3460 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3461 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3462 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3463 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3464 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3465 }
3466 }
3467 }
3468
3469 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook for OBJFILE using a
3470 probe. Return true if a breakpoint was installed. */
3471
3472 static bool
3473 create_exception_master_breakpoint_probe (objfile *objfile)
3474 {
3475 struct breakpoint *b;
3476 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3477 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3478
3479 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3480
3481 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3482 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3483 {
3484 std::vector<probe *> ret
3485 = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3486
3487 if (!ret.empty ())
3488 {
3489 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3490 probe *p = ret[0];
3491
3492 if (!p->can_evaluate_arguments ())
3493 {
3494 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3495 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3496 ret.clear ();
3497 }
3498 }
3499 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3500 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3501 }
3502
3503 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes.empty ())
3504 return false;
3505
3506 gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
3507
3508 for (probe *p : bp_objfile_data->exception_probes)
3509 {
3510 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3511 p->get_relocated_address (objfile),
3512 bp_exception_master,
3513 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3514 b->location = new_probe_location ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3515 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3516 }
3517
3518 return true;
3519 }
3520
3521 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook for OBJFILE using
3522 _Unwind_DebugHook. Return true if a breakpoint was installed. */
3523
3524 static bool
3525 create_exception_master_breakpoint_hook (objfile *objfile)
3526 {
3527 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3528 struct breakpoint *b;
3529 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3530 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3531 CORE_ADDR addr;
3532 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
3533
3534 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3535
3536 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3537 return false;
3538
3539 gdbarch = objfile->arch ();
3540
3541 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3542 {
3543 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3544
3545 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3546 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3547 {
3548 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3549 return false;
3550 }
3551
3552 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3553 }
3554
3555 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3556 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr
3557 (gdbarch, addr, current_inferior ()->top_target ());
3558 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3559 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3560 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3561 explicit_loc.function_name = ASTRDUP (func_name);
3562 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
3563 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3564
3565 return true;
3566 }
3567
3568 /* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3569
3570 static void
3571 create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3572 {
3573 for (objfile *obj : current_program_space->objfiles ())
3574 {
3575 /* Skip separate debug object. */
3576 if (obj->separate_debug_objfile_backlink)
3577 continue;
3578
3579 /* Try a probe kind breakpoint. */
3580 if (create_exception_master_breakpoint_probe (obj))
3581 continue;
3582
3583 /* Iterate over main and separate debug objects and try an
3584 _Unwind_DebugHook kind breakpoint. */
3585 for (objfile *debug_objfile : obj->separate_debug_objfiles ())
3586 if (create_exception_master_breakpoint_hook (debug_objfile))
3587 break;
3588 }
3589 }
3590
3591 /* Does B have a location spec? */
3592
3593 static int
3594 breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (const struct breakpoint *b)
3595 {
3596 return b->location != NULL && event_location_empty_p (b->location.get ());
3597 }
3598
3599 void
3600 update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3601 {
3602 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3603 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3604 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3605 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3606 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3607 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3608 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3609 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3610 for (bp_location *bploc : all_bp_locations ())
3611 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3612 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3613
3614 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
3615 {
3616 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3617 continue;
3618
3619 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3620 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3621 {
3622 delete_breakpoint (b);
3623 continue;
3624 }
3625
3626 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3627 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3628 {
3629 delete_breakpoint (b);
3630 continue;
3631 }
3632
3633 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3634 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3635 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3636 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3637 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3638 {
3639 delete_breakpoint (b);
3640 continue;
3641 }
3642
3643 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3644 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3645 {
3646 delete_breakpoint (b);
3647 continue;
3648 }
3649
3650 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3651 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3652 {
3653 delete_breakpoint (b);
3654 continue;
3655 }
3656
3657 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3658 after an exec. */
3659 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3660 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3661 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3662 {
3663 delete_breakpoint (b);
3664 continue;
3665 }
3666
3667 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3668 {
3669 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3670 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3671 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3672 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3673 continue;
3674 }
3675
3676 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3677 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3678 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3679 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3680 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3681 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3682
3683 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3684 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3685 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3686 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3687 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3688 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3689 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3690
3691 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3692 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3693 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3694 let finish_command delete it.
3695
3696 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3697 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3698 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3699 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3700 solib breakpoints.) */
3701
3702 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3703 {
3704 continue;
3705 }
3706
3707 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3708 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3709 a.out. */
3710 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
3711 {
3712 delete_breakpoint (b);
3713 continue;
3714 }
3715 }
3716 }
3717
3718 int
3719 detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3720 {
3721 int val = 0;
3722 scoped_restore save_inferior_ptid = make_scoped_restore (&inferior_ptid);
3723 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3724
3725 if (ptid.pid () == inferior_ptid.pid ())
3726 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3727
3728 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3729 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3730 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3731 {
3732 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3733 continue;
3734
3735 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3736 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3737 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3738 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3739 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3740 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3741 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3742 continue;
3743
3744 if (bl->inserted)
3745 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3746 }
3747
3748 return val;
3749 }
3750
3751 /* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3752 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3753 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3754 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3755 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3756
3757 static int
3758 remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
3759 {
3760 int val;
3761
3762 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3763 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3764
3765 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3766 This should not ever happen. */
3767 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3768
3769 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3770 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3771 {
3772 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3773 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3774 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3775
3776 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3777 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3778 || bl->section == NULL
3779 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3780 {
3781 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3782
3783 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3784 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3785 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3786 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3787 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3788 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3789 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3790 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3791 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3792 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3793 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3794 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3795 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3796 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3797 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3798 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3799 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3800 they should always be removed. */
3801 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3802 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3803 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3804 val = 0;
3805 else
3806 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3807 }
3808 else
3809 {
3810 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3811 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3812 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3813 {
3814 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3815 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3816 */
3817 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3818 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3819 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3820 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3821 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3822 else
3823 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3824 &bl->overlay_target_info,
3825 reason);
3826 }
3827 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3828 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3829 if (bl->inserted)
3830 {
3831 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3832 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3833 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3834 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3835
3836 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3837 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3838 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3839 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3840 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3841 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3842 else
3843 val = 0;
3844 }
3845 else
3846 {
3847 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3848 val = 0;
3849 }
3850 }
3851
3852 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3853 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3854 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3855 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3856 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3857 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3858 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3859 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3860 always-inserted mode. */
3861 if (val
3862 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3863 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3864 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3865 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3866 bl->address))))
3867 val = 0;
3868
3869 if (val)
3870 return val;
3871 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3872 }
3873 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3874 {
3875 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3876 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3877
3878 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3879 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3880
3881 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
3882 if (reason == REMOVE_BREAKPOINT && bl->inserted)
3883 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
3884 bl->owner->number);
3885 }
3886 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
3887 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
3888 && !bl->duplicate)
3889 {
3890 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
3891 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
3892
3893 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl, reason);
3894 if (val)
3895 return val;
3896
3897 bl->inserted = (reason == DETACH_BREAKPOINT);
3898 }
3899
3900 return 0;
3901 }
3902
3903 static int
3904 remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
3905 {
3906 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3907 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3908
3909 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3910 This should not ever happen. */
3911 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3912
3913 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
3914
3915 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3916
3917 return remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, REMOVE_BREAKPOINT);
3918 }
3919
3920 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
3921
3922 void
3923 mark_breakpoints_out (void)
3924 {
3925 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
3926 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space)
3927 bl->inserted = 0;
3928 }
3929
3930 /* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
3931 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
3932
3933 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
3934 between runs.
3935
3936 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
3937 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
3938 init_wait_for_inferior). */
3939
3940
3941
3942 void
3943 breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
3944 {
3945 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
3946
3947 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
3948 nothing to do. */
3949 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
3950 return;
3951
3952 mark_breakpoints_out ();
3953
3954 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
3955 {
3956 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
3957 continue;
3958
3959 switch (b->type)
3960 {
3961 case bp_call_dummy:
3962 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
3963
3964 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
3965 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
3966 rid of it. */
3967
3968 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
3969
3970 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
3971
3972 case bp_shlib_event:
3973
3974 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
3975 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
3976 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
3977 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
3978 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
3979
3980 (gdb) file prog-linux
3981 (gdb) run # native linux target
3982 ...
3983 (gdb) kill
3984 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
3985 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
3986 */
3987
3988 case bp_step_resume:
3989
3990 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
3991
3992 case bp_single_step:
3993
3994 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
3995
3996 delete_breakpoint (b);
3997 break;
3998
3999 case bp_watchpoint:
4000 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4001 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4002 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4003 {
4004 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4005
4006 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
4007 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
4008 delete_breakpoint (b);
4009 else
4010 {
4011 /* Get rid of existing locations, which are no longer
4012 valid. New ones will be created in
4013 update_watchpoint, when the inferior is restarted.
4014 The next update_global_location_list call will
4015 garbage collect them. */
4016 b->loc = NULL;
4017
4018 if (context == inf_starting)
4019 {
4020 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
4021 insert_breakpoints. */
4022 w->val.reset (nullptr);
4023 w->val_valid = false;
4024 }
4025 }
4026 }
4027 break;
4028 default:
4029 break;
4030 }
4031 }
4032
4033 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
4034 for (bp_location *bl : moribund_locations)
4035 decref_bp_location (&bl);
4036 moribund_locations.clear ();
4037 }
4038
4039 /* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
4040 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
4041 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
4042 match, not program space. */
4043
4044 /* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
4045 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
4046 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
4047 permanent breakpoint.
4048 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
4049 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
4050 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
4051 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
4052 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
4053
4054 enum breakpoint_here
4055 breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4056 {
4057 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
4058
4059 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
4060 {
4061 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4062 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4063 continue;
4064
4065 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
4066 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4067 || bl->permanent)
4068 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4069 {
4070 if (overlay_debugging
4071 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4072 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4073 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4074 else if (bl->permanent)
4075 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
4076 else
4077 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
4078 }
4079 }
4080
4081 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : no_breakpoint_here;
4082 }
4083
4084 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4085
4086 int
4087 breakpoint_in_range_p (const address_space *aspace,
4088 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4089 {
4090 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
4091 {
4092 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4093 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4094 continue;
4095
4096 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4097 || bl->permanent)
4098 && breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (bl, aspace,
4099 addr, len))
4100 {
4101 if (overlay_debugging
4102 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4103 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4104 {
4105 /* Unmapped overlay -- can't be a match. */
4106 continue;
4107 }
4108
4109 return 1;
4110 }
4111 }
4112
4113 return 0;
4114 }
4115
4116 /* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4117
4118 int
4119 moribund_breakpoint_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4120 {
4121 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
4122 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4123 return 1;
4124
4125 return 0;
4126 }
4127
4128 /* Returns non-zero iff BL is inserted at PC, in address space
4129 ASPACE. */
4130
4131 static int
4132 bp_location_inserted_here_p (struct bp_location *bl,
4133 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4134 {
4135 if (bl->inserted
4136 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4137 aspace, pc))
4138 {
4139 if (overlay_debugging
4140 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4141 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4142 return 0; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4143 else
4144 return 1;
4145 }
4146 return 0;
4147 }
4148
4149 /* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4150
4151 int
4152 breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4153 {
4154 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc))
4155 {
4156 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4157 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4158 continue;
4159
4160 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4161 return 1;
4162 }
4163 return 0;
4164 }
4165
4166 /* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4167 inserted at PC. */
4168
4169 int
4170 software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4171 CORE_ADDR pc)
4172 {
4173 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc))
4174 {
4175 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4176 continue;
4177
4178 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4179 return 1;
4180 }
4181
4182 return 0;
4183 }
4184
4185 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4186
4187 int
4188 hardware_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
4189 CORE_ADDR pc)
4190 {
4191 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations_at_addr (pc))
4192 {
4193 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4194 continue;
4195
4196 if (bp_location_inserted_here_p (bl, aspace, pc))
4197 return 1;
4198 }
4199
4200 return 0;
4201 }
4202
4203 int
4204 hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (const address_space *aspace,
4205 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4206 {
4207 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
4208 {
4209 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4210 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4211 continue;
4212
4213 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4214 continue;
4215
4216 for (bp_location *loc : bpt->locations ())
4217 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4218 {
4219 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4220
4221 /* Check for intersection. */
4222 l = std::max<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address, addr);
4223 h = std::min<CORE_ADDR> (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4224 if (l < h)
4225 return 1;
4226 }
4227 }
4228 return 0;
4229 }
4230
4231 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4232
4233 bool
4234 is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
4235 {
4236 return (b->type == bp_catchpoint);
4237 }
4238
4239 /* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4240 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4241
4242 void
4243 bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4244 {
4245 bpstat p;
4246 bpstat q;
4247
4248 if (bsp == 0)
4249 return;
4250 p = *bsp;
4251 while (p != NULL)
4252 {
4253 q = p->next;
4254 delete p;
4255 p = q;
4256 }
4257 *bsp = NULL;
4258 }
4259
4260 bpstats::bpstats (const bpstats &other)
4261 : next (NULL),
4262 bp_location_at (other.bp_location_at),
4263 breakpoint_at (other.breakpoint_at),
4264 commands (other.commands),
4265 print (other.print),
4266 stop (other.stop),
4267 print_it (other.print_it)
4268 {
4269 if (other.old_val != NULL)
4270 old_val = release_value (value_copy (other.old_val.get ()));
4271 }
4272
4273 /* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4274 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4275
4276 bpstat
4277 bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4278 {
4279 bpstat p = NULL;
4280 bpstat tmp;
4281 bpstat retval = NULL;
4282
4283 if (bs == NULL)
4284 return bs;
4285
4286 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4287 {
4288 tmp = new bpstats (*bs);
4289
4290 if (p == NULL)
4291 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4292 retval = tmp;
4293 else
4294 p->next = tmp;
4295 p = tmp;
4296 }
4297 p->next = NULL;
4298 return retval;
4299 }
4300
4301 /* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4302
4303 bpstat
4304 bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4305 {
4306 if (bsp == NULL)
4307 return NULL;
4308
4309 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4310 {
4311 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4312 return bsp;
4313 }
4314 return NULL;
4315 }
4316
4317 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4318
4319 bool
4320 bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4321 {
4322 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4323 {
4324 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4325 {
4326 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4327 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4328 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4329 return true;
4330 }
4331 else
4332 {
4333 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4334 sig))
4335 return true;
4336 }
4337 }
4338
4339 return false;
4340 }
4341
4342 /* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4343 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4344 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4345 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4346
4347 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4348 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4349 we set it.
4350 Return 1 otherwise. */
4351
4352 int
4353 bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4354 {
4355 struct breakpoint *b;
4356
4357 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4358 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4359
4360 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4361 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4362 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4363 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4364 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4365 if (b == NULL)
4366 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4367
4368 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4369 return 1;
4370 }
4371
4372 /* See breakpoint.h. */
4373
4374 void
4375 bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4376 {
4377 bpstat bs;
4378
4379 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid)
4380 return;
4381
4382 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4383 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4384 {
4385 bs->commands = NULL;
4386 bs->old_val.reset (nullptr);
4387 }
4388 }
4389
4390 /* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4391
4392 static void
4393 breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4394 {
4395 if (inferior_ptid != null_ptid)
4396 {
4397 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4398
4399 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4400 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4401 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4402 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4403 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4404 return;
4405 }
4406
4407 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4408 }
4409
4410 /* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4411 or its equivalent. */
4412
4413 static int
4414 command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4415 {
4416 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0);
4417 }
4418
4419 /* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4420 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4421 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4422 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4423
4424 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4425 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4426 bpstat of the current thread. */
4427
4428 static int
4429 bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4430 {
4431 bpstat bs;
4432 int again = 0;
4433
4434 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4435 in bs->commands. */
4436 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4437 return 0;
4438
4439 scoped_restore save_executing
4440 = make_scoped_restore (&executing_breakpoint_commands, 1);
4441
4442 scoped_restore preventer = prevent_dont_repeat ();
4443
4444 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4445 bs = *bsp;
4446
4447 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4448 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4449 {
4450 struct command_line *cmd = NULL;
4451
4452 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4453
4454 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4455 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4456 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4457 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4458 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4459 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4460 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4461 the tree when we're done. */
4462 counted_command_line ccmd = bs->commands;
4463 bs->commands = NULL;
4464 if (ccmd != NULL)
4465 cmd = ccmd.get ();
4466 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4467 {
4468 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4469 cmd = cmd->next;
4470 }
4471
4472 while (cmd != NULL)
4473 {
4474 execute_control_command (cmd);
4475
4476 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4477 break;
4478 else
4479 cmd = cmd->next;
4480 }
4481
4482 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4483 {
4484 if (current_ui->async)
4485 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4486 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4487 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4488 ;
4489 else
4490 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4491 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4492 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4493 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4494 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4495 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4496 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4497 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4498 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4499 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4500 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4501 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4502 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4503 again = 1;
4504 break;
4505 }
4506 }
4507 return again;
4508 }
4509
4510 /* Helper for bpstat_do_actions. Get the current thread, if there's
4511 one, is alive and has execution. Return NULL otherwise. */
4512
4513 static thread_info *
4514 get_bpstat_thread ()
4515 {
4516 if (inferior_ptid == null_ptid || !target_has_execution ())
4517 return NULL;
4518
4519 thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4520 if (tp->state == THREAD_EXITED || tp->executing)
4521 return NULL;
4522 return tp;
4523 }
4524
4525 void
4526 bpstat_do_actions (void)
4527 {
4528 auto cleanup_if_error = make_scope_exit (bpstat_clear_actions);
4529 thread_info *tp;
4530
4531 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4532 while ((tp = get_bpstat_thread ()) != NULL)
4533 {
4534 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the
4535 inferior, and only return when it is stopped at the next
4536 breakpoint, we keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns
4537 false to indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4538 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tp->control.stop_bpstat))
4539 break;
4540 }
4541
4542 cleanup_if_error.release ();
4543 }
4544
4545 /* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4546
4547 static void
4548 watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4549 {
4550 if (val == NULL)
4551 fprintf_styled (stream, metadata_style.style (), _("<unreadable>"));
4552 else
4553 {
4554 struct value_print_options opts;
4555 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4556 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4557 }
4558 }
4559
4560 /* Print the "Thread ID hit" part of "Thread ID hit Breakpoint N" if
4561 debugging multiple threads. */
4562
4563 void
4564 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (struct ui_out *uiout)
4565 {
4566 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4567 return;
4568
4569 uiout->text ("\n");
4570
4571 if (show_thread_that_caused_stop ())
4572 {
4573 const char *name;
4574 struct thread_info *thr = inferior_thread ();
4575
4576 uiout->text ("Thread ");
4577 uiout->field_string ("thread-id", print_thread_id (thr));
4578
4579 name = thr->name != NULL ? thr->name : target_thread_name (thr);
4580 if (name != NULL)
4581 {
4582 uiout->text (" \"");
4583 uiout->field_string ("name", name);
4584 uiout->text ("\"");
4585 }
4586
4587 uiout->text (" hit ");
4588 }
4589 }
4590
4591 /* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4592 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4593 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4594 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4595 normal_stop(). */
4596
4597 static enum print_stop_action
4598 print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4599 {
4600 switch (bs->print_it)
4601 {
4602 case print_it_noop:
4603 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4604 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4605 break;
4606
4607 case print_it_done:
4608 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4609 relevant messages. */
4610 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4611 break;
4612
4613 case print_it_normal:
4614 {
4615 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4616
4617 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4618 which has since been deleted. */
4619 if (b == NULL)
4620 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4621
4622 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4623 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4624 }
4625 break;
4626
4627 default:
4628 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4629 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4630 break;
4631 }
4632 }
4633
4634 /* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4635
4636 static void
4637 print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4638 {
4639 bool any_deleted = !current_program_space->deleted_solibs.empty ();
4640 bool any_added = !current_program_space->added_solibs.empty ();
4641
4642 if (!is_catchpoint)
4643 {
4644 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4645 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4646 else
4647 current_uiout->text (_("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4648 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4649 }
4650
4651 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
4652 current_uiout->field_string ("reason",
4653 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4654
4655 if (any_deleted)
4656 {
4657 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior unloaded "));
4658 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "removed");
4659 for (int ix = 0; ix < current_program_space->deleted_solibs.size (); ix++)
4660 {
4661 const std::string &name = current_program_space->deleted_solibs[ix];
4662
4663 if (ix > 0)
4664 current_uiout->text (" ");
4665 current_uiout->field_string ("library", name);
4666 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4667 }
4668 }
4669
4670 if (any_added)
4671 {
4672 current_uiout->text (_(" Inferior loaded "));
4673 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (current_uiout, "added");
4674 bool first = true;
4675 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
4676 {
4677 if (!first)
4678 current_uiout->text (" ");
4679 first = false;
4680 current_uiout->field_string ("library", iter->so_name);
4681 current_uiout->text ("\n");
4682 }
4683 }
4684 }
4685
4686 /* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4687 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4688 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4689 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4690 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4691 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4692 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4693 routine is one of:
4694
4695 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4696 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4697 code to print the location. An example is
4698 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4699 the location.
4700 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4701 to also print the location part of the message.
4702 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4703 don't require a location appended to the end.
4704 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4705 further info to be printed. */
4706
4707 enum print_stop_action
4708 bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4709 {
4710 enum print_stop_action val;
4711
4712 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4713 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4714 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4715 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4716 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4717 {
4718 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4719 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4720 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4721 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4722 return val;
4723 }
4724
4725 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4726 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4727 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4728 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4729 {
4730 print_solib_event (0);
4731 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4732 }
4733
4734 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4735 with and nothing was printed. */
4736 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4737 }
4738
4739 /* Evaluate the boolean expression EXP and return the result. */
4740
4741 static bool
4742 breakpoint_cond_eval (expression *exp)
4743 {
4744 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4745 bool res = value_true (evaluate_expression (exp));
4746
4747 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4748 return res;
4749 }
4750
4751 /* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4752
4753 bpstats::bpstats (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4754 : next (NULL),
4755 bp_location_at (bp_location_ref_ptr::new_reference (bl)),
4756 breakpoint_at (bl->owner),
4757 commands (NULL),
4758 print (0),
4759 stop (0),
4760 print_it (print_it_normal)
4761 {
4762 **bs_link_pointer = this;
4763 *bs_link_pointer = &next;
4764 }
4765
4766 bpstats::bpstats ()
4767 : next (NULL),
4768 breakpoint_at (NULL),
4769 commands (NULL),
4770 print (0),
4771 stop (0),
4772 print_it (print_it_normal)
4773 {
4774 }
4775 \f
4776 /* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4777 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4778
4779 int
4780 watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4781 {
4782 bool stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4783 CORE_ADDR addr;
4784
4785 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4786 {
4787 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4788 as not triggered. */
4789 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
4790 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4791 {
4792 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4793
4794 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4795 }
4796
4797 return 0;
4798 }
4799
4800 if (!target_stopped_data_address (current_inferior ()->top_target (), &addr))
4801 {
4802 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4803 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4804 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
4805 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4806 {
4807 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4808
4809 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4810 }
4811
4812 return 1;
4813 }
4814
4815 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4816 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4817 triggered. */
4818
4819 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
4820 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4821 {
4822 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4823
4824 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4825 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
4826 {
4827 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4828 {
4829 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4830 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4831
4832 if (newaddr == start)
4833 {
4834 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4835 break;
4836 }
4837 }
4838 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4839 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range
4840 (current_inferior ()->top_target (), addr, loc->address,
4841 loc->length))
4842 {
4843 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4844 break;
4845 }
4846 }
4847 }
4848
4849 return 1;
4850 }
4851
4852 /* Possible return values for watchpoint_check. */
4853 enum wp_check_result
4854 {
4855 /* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4856 WP_DELETED = 1,
4857
4858 /* The value has changed. */
4859 WP_VALUE_CHANGED = 2,
4860
4861 /* The value has not changed. */
4862 WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED = 3,
4863
4864 /* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4865 WP_IGNORE = 4,
4866 };
4867
4868 #define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4869 #define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4870
4871 /* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4872 changed. */
4873
4874 static wp_check_result
4875 watchpoint_check (bpstat bs)
4876 {
4877 struct watchpoint *b;
4878 struct frame_info *fr;
4879 int within_current_scope;
4880
4881 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4882 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4883 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4884
4885 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4886 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4887 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4888 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4889 return WP_IGNORE;
4890
4891 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4892 within_current_scope = 1;
4893 else
4894 {
4895 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4896 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4897 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4898
4899 /* stack_frame_destroyed_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
4900 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
4901 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
4902 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
4903 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
4904 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
4905 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
4906 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
4907 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
4908 if (gdbarch_stack_frame_destroyed_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
4909 return WP_IGNORE;
4910
4911 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
4912 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
4913
4914 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
4915 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
4916 if (within_current_scope)
4917 {
4918 struct symbol *function;
4919
4920 function = get_frame_function (fr);
4921 if (function == NULL
4922 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
4923 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
4924 within_current_scope = 0;
4925 }
4926
4927 if (within_current_scope)
4928 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
4929 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
4930 the user. */
4931 select_frame (fr);
4932 }
4933
4934 if (within_current_scope)
4935 {
4936 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
4937 time before we return to the command level and call
4938 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
4939 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
4940
4941 struct value *mark;
4942 struct value *new_val;
4943
4944 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4945 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
4946 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
4947 a mask watchpoint. */
4948 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4949
4950 mark = value_mark ();
4951 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp.get (), b->exp->op.get (), &new_val,
4952 NULL, NULL, false);
4953
4954 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
4955 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
4956
4957 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
4958 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
4959 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
4960 not what we want. */
4961 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
4962 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val.get (),
4963 new_val)))
4964 {
4965 bs->old_val = b->val;
4966 b->val = release_value (new_val);
4967 b->val_valid = true;
4968 if (new_val != NULL)
4969 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4970 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
4971 }
4972 else
4973 {
4974 /* Nothing changed. */
4975 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4976 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
4977 }
4978 }
4979 else
4980 {
4981 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
4982 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
4983 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
4984 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
4985 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
4986 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
4987 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
4988 the first value assigned). */
4989 /* We print all the stop information in
4990 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
4991 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
4992 already. So we have no choice but print the information
4993 here. */
4994
4995 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
4996 {
4997 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
4998
4999 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5000 uiout->field_string
5001 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
5002 uiout->message ("\nWatchpoint %pF deleted because the program has "
5003 "left the block in\n"
5004 "which its expression is valid.\n",
5005 signed_field ("wpnum", b->number));
5006 }
5007
5008 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
5009 b->commands = NULL;
5010 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5011
5012 return WP_DELETED;
5013 }
5014 }
5015
5016 /* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
5017 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
5018 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
5019
5020 static int
5021 bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
5022 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5023 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5024 {
5025 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
5026
5027 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
5028 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5029
5030 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5031 }
5032
5033 /* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
5034 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
5035
5036 static void
5037 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
5038 {
5039 const struct bp_location *bl;
5040 struct watchpoint *b;
5041
5042 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5043 bl = bs->bp_location_at.get ();
5044 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5045 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5046 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5047
5048 {
5049 int must_check_value = 0;
5050
5051 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5052 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5053 watched value. */
5054 must_check_value = 1;
5055 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5056 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5057 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5058 this watchpoint. */
5059 must_check_value = 1;
5060 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5061 && b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5062 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5063 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5064 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5065 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5066 must_check_value = 1;
5067
5068 if (must_check_value)
5069 {
5070 wp_check_result e;
5071
5072 try
5073 {
5074 e = watchpoint_check (bs);
5075 }
5076 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
5077 {
5078 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5079 "Error evaluating expression "
5080 "for watchpoint %d\n",
5081 b->number);
5082
5083 SWITCH_THRU_ALL_UIS ()
5084 {
5085 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"),
5086 b->number);
5087 }
5088 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5089 e = WP_DELETED;
5090 }
5091
5092 switch (e)
5093 {
5094 case WP_DELETED:
5095 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5096 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5097 /* Stop. */
5098 break;
5099 case WP_IGNORE:
5100 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5101 bs->stop = 0;
5102 break;
5103 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5104 if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5105 {
5106 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5107
5108 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5109 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5110 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5111 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5112 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5113 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5114 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5115 old value.
5116
5117 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5118 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5119 happen:
5120
5121 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5122 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5123 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5124 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5125
5126 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5127 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5128 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5129 watchpoint.
5130
5131 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5132 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5133 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5134 changes. This still gives false positives when
5135 the program writes the same value to memory as
5136 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5137 it for a read), but it's much better than
5138 nothing. */
5139
5140 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5141
5142 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5143 {
5144 for (breakpoint *other_b : all_breakpoints ())
5145 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5146 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5147 {
5148 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5149 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5150
5151 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5152 == watch_triggered_yes)
5153 {
5154 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5155 break;
5156 }
5157 }
5158 }
5159
5160 if (other_write_watchpoint
5161 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5162 {
5163 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5164 and the value changed since the last time we
5165 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5166 Ignore it. */
5167 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5168 bs->stop = 0;
5169 }
5170 }
5171 break;
5172 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5173 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5174 || b->type == bp_watchpoint)
5175 {
5176 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5177 the value hasn't changed. */
5178 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5179 bs->stop = 0;
5180 }
5181 /* Stop. */
5182 break;
5183 default:
5184 /* Can't happen. */
5185 break;
5186 }
5187 }
5188 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5189 {
5190 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5191 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5192 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5193 anything for this watchpoint. */
5194 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5195 bs->stop = 0;
5196 }
5197 }
5198 }
5199
5200 /* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5201 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5202 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5203 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5204
5205 static void
5206 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, thread_info *thread)
5207 {
5208 const struct bp_location *bl;
5209 struct breakpoint *b;
5210 /* Assume stop. */
5211 bool condition_result = true;
5212 struct expression *cond;
5213
5214 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5215
5216 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5217 bl = bs->bp_location_at.get ();
5218 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5219 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5220 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5221
5222 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5223 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5224 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5225
5226 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5227 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5228 {
5229 bs->stop = 0;
5230 return;
5231 }
5232
5233 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5234 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5235 thread/task. */
5236 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != thread->global_num)
5237 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (thread)))
5238 {
5239 bs->stop = 0;
5240 return;
5241 }
5242
5243 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5244 implemented. */
5245 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5246
5247 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5248 {
5249 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5250
5251 cond = w->cond_exp.get ();
5252 }
5253 else
5254 cond = bl->cond.get ();
5255
5256 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5257 {
5258 int within_current_scope = 1;
5259 struct watchpoint * w;
5260
5261 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5262 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5263 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5264 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5265 function call. */
5266 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5267
5268 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5269 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5270 else
5271 w = NULL;
5272
5273 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5274 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5275 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5276 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5277 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5278 call site. */
5279 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5280 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5281 else
5282 {
5283 struct frame_info *frame;
5284
5285 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5286 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5287 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5288 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5289 really matter which instantiation of the function
5290 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5291 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5292 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5293 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5294 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5295 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5296 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5297 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5298 intuitive. */
5299 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5300 if (frame != NULL)
5301 select_frame (frame);
5302 else
5303 within_current_scope = 0;
5304 }
5305 if (within_current_scope)
5306 {
5307 try
5308 {
5309 condition_result = breakpoint_cond_eval (cond);
5310 }
5311 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
5312 {
5313 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
5314 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n");
5315 }
5316 }
5317 else
5318 {
5319 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5320 "in the current scope"));
5321 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5322 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5323 }
5324 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5325 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5326 }
5327
5328 if (cond && !condition_result)
5329 {
5330 bs->stop = 0;
5331 }
5332 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5333 {
5334 b->ignore_count--;
5335 bs->stop = 0;
5336 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5337 ++(b->hit_count);
5338 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5339 }
5340 }
5341
5342 /* Returns true if we need to track moribund locations of LOC's type
5343 on the current target. */
5344
5345 static int
5346 need_moribund_for_location_type (struct bp_location *loc)
5347 {
5348 return ((loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
5349 && !target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ())
5350 || (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
5351 && !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ()));
5352 }
5353
5354 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5355
5356 bpstat
5357 build_bpstat_chain (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5358 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5359 {
5360 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5361
5362 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
5363 {
5364 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5365 continue;
5366
5367 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
5368 {
5369 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5370 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5371 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5372 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5373 checked all locations already. */
5374 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5375 break;
5376
5377 if (!bl->enabled || bl->disabled_by_cond || bl->shlib_disabled)
5378 continue;
5379
5380 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5381 continue;
5382
5383 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5384 matches. */
5385
5386 bpstat bs = new bpstats (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5387 explain stop. */
5388
5389 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5390 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5391 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5392 bs->stop = 1;
5393 bs->print = 1;
5394
5395 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5396 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5397 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5398 iteration. */
5399 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5400 {
5401 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5402
5403 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5404 }
5405 }
5406 }
5407
5408 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5409 if (!target_supports_stopped_by_sw_breakpoint ()
5410 || !target_supports_stopped_by_hw_breakpoint ())
5411 {
5412 for (bp_location *loc : moribund_locations)
5413 {
5414 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr)
5415 && need_moribund_for_location_type (loc))
5416 {
5417 bpstat bs = new bpstats (loc, &bs_link);
5418 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5419 bs->stop = 0;
5420 bs->print = 0;
5421 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5422 }
5423 }
5424 }
5425
5426 return bs_head;
5427 }
5428
5429 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5430
5431 bpstat
5432 bpstat_stop_status (const address_space *aspace,
5433 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, thread_info *thread,
5434 const struct target_waitstatus *ws,
5435 bpstat stop_chain)
5436 {
5437 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5438 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5439 bpstat bs_head = stop_chain;
5440 bpstat bs;
5441 int need_remove_insert;
5442 int removed_any;
5443
5444 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5445 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5446 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5447 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5448 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5449 inferior function calls. */
5450 if (bs_head == NULL)
5451 bs_head = build_bpstat_chain (aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5452
5453 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5454 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5455 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5456 "catch unload". */
5457 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5458 {
5459 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5460 {
5461 handle_solib_event ();
5462 break;
5463 }
5464 }
5465
5466 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5467 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5468 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5469
5470 removed_any = 0;
5471
5472 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5473 {
5474 if (!bs->stop)
5475 continue;
5476
5477 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5478 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5479 if (bs->stop)
5480 {
5481 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, thread);
5482
5483 if (bs->stop)
5484 {
5485 ++(b->hit_count);
5486 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
5487
5488 /* We will stop here. */
5489 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5490 {
5491 --(b->enable_count);
5492 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5493 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5494 removed_any = 1;
5495 }
5496 if (b->silent)
5497 bs->print = 0;
5498 bs->commands = b->commands;
5499 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5500 ? bs->commands.get () : NULL))
5501 bs->print = 0;
5502
5503 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5504 }
5505
5506 }
5507
5508 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5509 print. */
5510 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5511 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5512 }
5513
5514 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5515 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5516 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5517 done later. */
5518 need_remove_insert = 0;
5519 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5520 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5521 if (!bs->stop
5522 && bs->breakpoint_at
5523 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5524 {
5525 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5526
5527 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5528 need_remove_insert = 1;
5529 }
5530
5531 if (need_remove_insert)
5532 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5533 else if (removed_any)
5534 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5535
5536 return bs_head;
5537 }
5538
5539 static void
5540 handle_jit_event (CORE_ADDR address)
5541 {
5542 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5543
5544 infrun_debug_printf ("handling bp_jit_event");
5545
5546 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5547 breakpoint_re_set. */
5548 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
5549
5550 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (get_current_frame ());
5551 /* This event is caused by a breakpoint set in `jit_breakpoint_re_set`,
5552 thus it is expected that its objectfile can be found through
5553 minimal symbol lookup. If it doesn't work (and assert fails), it
5554 most likely means that `jit_breakpoint_re_set` was changes and this
5555 function needs to be updated too. */
5556 bound_minimal_symbol jit_bp_sym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (address);
5557 gdb_assert (jit_bp_sym.objfile != nullptr);
5558 jit_event_handler (gdbarch, jit_bp_sym.objfile);
5559
5560 target_terminal::inferior ();
5561 }
5562
5563 /* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5564
5565 /* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5566
5567 struct bpstat_what
5568 bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5569 {
5570 struct bpstat_what retval;
5571 bpstat bs;
5572
5573 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5574 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5575 retval.is_longjmp = false;
5576
5577 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5578 {
5579 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5580 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5581 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5582 enum bptype bptype;
5583
5584 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5585 {
5586 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5587 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5588 bptype = bp_none;
5589 }
5590 else
5591 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5592
5593 switch (bptype)
5594 {
5595 case bp_none:
5596 break;
5597 case bp_breakpoint:
5598 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5599 case bp_single_step:
5600 case bp_until:
5601 case bp_finish:
5602 case bp_shlib_event:
5603 if (bs->stop)
5604 {
5605 if (bs->print)
5606 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5607 else
5608 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5609 }
5610 else
5611 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5612 break;
5613 case bp_watchpoint:
5614 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5615 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5616 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5617 if (bs->stop)
5618 {
5619 if (bs->print)
5620 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5621 else
5622 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5623 }
5624 else
5625 {
5626 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5627 This requires no further action. */
5628 }
5629 break;
5630 case bp_longjmp:
5631 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5632 case bp_exception:
5633 if (bs->stop)
5634 {
5635 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5636 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5637 }
5638 else
5639 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5640 break;
5641 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5642 case bp_exception_resume:
5643 if (bs->stop)
5644 {
5645 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5646 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5647 }
5648 else
5649 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5650 break;
5651 case bp_step_resume:
5652 if (bs->stop)
5653 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5654 else
5655 {
5656 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5657 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5658 }
5659 break;
5660 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5661 if (bs->stop)
5662 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5663 else
5664 {
5665 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5666 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5667 }
5668 break;
5669 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5670 case bp_thread_event:
5671 case bp_overlay_event:
5672 case bp_longjmp_master:
5673 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5674 case bp_exception_master:
5675 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5676 break;
5677 case bp_catchpoint:
5678 if (bs->stop)
5679 {
5680 if (bs->print)
5681 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5682 else
5683 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5684 }
5685 else
5686 {
5687 /* Some catchpoints are implemented with breakpoints.
5688 For those, we need to step over the breakpoint. */
5689 if (bs->bp_location_at->loc_type != bp_loc_other)
5690 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5691 }
5692 break;
5693 case bp_jit_event:
5694 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5695 break;
5696 case bp_call_dummy:
5697 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5698 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5699 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5700 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5701 break;
5702 case bp_std_terminate:
5703 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5704 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5705 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5706 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5707 break;
5708 case bp_tracepoint:
5709 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5710 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5711 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5712 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5713 out already. */
5714 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5715 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5716 break;
5717 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5718 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5719 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5720 break;
5721 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5722 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5723 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5724 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5725 break;
5726
5727 case bp_dprintf:
5728 if (bs->stop)
5729 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5730 else
5731 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5732 break;
5733
5734 default:
5735 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5736 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5737 }
5738
5739 retval.main_action = std::max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5740 }
5741
5742 return retval;
5743 }
5744
5745 void
5746 bpstat_run_callbacks (bpstat bs_head)
5747 {
5748 bpstat bs;
5749
5750 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5751 {
5752 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5753
5754 if (b == NULL)
5755 continue;
5756 switch (b->type)
5757 {
5758 case bp_jit_event:
5759 handle_jit_event (bs->bp_location_at->address);
5760 break;
5761 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5762 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5763 break;
5764 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5765 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5766 break;
5767 }
5768 }
5769 }
5770
5771 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5772
5773 bool
5774 bpstat_should_step ()
5775 {
5776 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
5777 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5778 return true;
5779
5780 return false;
5781 }
5782
5783 /* See breakpoint.h. */
5784
5785 bool
5786 bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5787 {
5788 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5789 if (bs->stop)
5790 return true;
5791
5792 return false;
5793 }
5794
5795 \f
5796
5797 /* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5798 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5799 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5800
5801 static char *
5802 wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5803 {
5804 static char wrap_indent[80];
5805 int i, total_width, width, align;
5806 const char *text;
5807
5808 total_width = 0;
5809 for (i = 1; uiout->query_table_field (i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5810 {
5811 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5812 {
5813 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5814 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5815 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5816
5817 return wrap_indent;
5818 }
5819
5820 total_width += width + 1;
5821 }
5822
5823 return NULL;
5824 }
5825
5826 /* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5827 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5828
5829 "host": Host evals condition.
5830 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5831 "target": Target evals condition.
5832 */
5833
5834 static const char *
5835 bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5836 {
5837 char host_evals = 0;
5838 char target_evals = 0;
5839
5840 if (!b)
5841 return NULL;
5842
5843 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5844 return NULL;
5845
5846 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5847 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5848 return condition_evaluation_host;
5849
5850 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
5851 {
5852 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5853 target_evals++;
5854 else
5855 host_evals++;
5856 }
5857
5858 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5859 return condition_evaluation_both;
5860 else if (target_evals)
5861 return condition_evaluation_target;
5862 else
5863 return condition_evaluation_host;
5864 }
5865
5866 /* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5867 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5868
5869 static const char *
5870 bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5871 {
5872 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5873 return NULL;
5874
5875 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5876 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5877 return condition_evaluation_host;
5878
5879 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5880 return condition_evaluation_target;
5881 else
5882 return condition_evaluation_host;
5883 }
5884
5885 /* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5886
5887 static void
5888 print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5889 struct bp_location *loc)
5890 {
5891 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5892
5893 scoped_restore_current_program_space restore_pspace;
5894
5895 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5896 loc = NULL;
5897
5898 if (loc != NULL)
5899 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5900
5901 if (b->display_canonical)
5902 uiout->field_string ("what", event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5903 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5904 {
5905 const struct symbol *sym = loc->symbol;
5906
5907 if (sym)
5908 {
5909 uiout->text ("in ");
5910 uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (),
5911 function_name_style.style ());
5912 uiout->text (" ");
5913 uiout->wrap_hint (wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5914 uiout->text ("at ");
5915 }
5916 uiout->field_string ("file",
5917 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab),
5918 file_name_style.style ());
5919 uiout->text (":");
5920
5921 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
5922 uiout->field_string ("fullname", symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5923
5924 uiout->field_signed ("line", loc->line_number);
5925 }
5926 else if (loc)
5927 {
5928 string_file stb;
5929
5930 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, &stb,
5931 demangle, "");
5932 uiout->field_stream ("at", stb);
5933 }
5934 else
5935 {
5936 uiout->field_string ("pending",
5937 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
5938 /* If extra_string is available, it could be holding a condition
5939 or dprintf arguments. In either case, make sure it is printed,
5940 too, but only for non-MI streams. */
5941 if (!uiout->is_mi_like_p () && b->extra_string != NULL)
5942 {
5943 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
5944 uiout->text (",");
5945 else
5946 uiout->text (" ");
5947 uiout->text (b->extra_string);
5948 }
5949 }
5950
5951 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
5952 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
5953 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
5954 {
5955 uiout->text (" (");
5956 uiout->field_string ("evaluated-by",
5957 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
5958 uiout->text (")");
5959 }
5960 }
5961
5962 static const char *
5963 bptype_string (enum bptype type)
5964 {
5965 struct ep_type_description
5966 {
5967 enum bptype type;
5968 const char *description;
5969 };
5970 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
5971 {
5972 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
5973 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
5974 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
5975 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
5976 {bp_until, "until"},
5977 {bp_finish, "finish"},
5978 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
5979 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
5980 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
5981 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
5982 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
5983 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
5984 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
5985 {bp_exception, "exception"},
5986 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
5987 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
5988 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
5989 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
5990 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
5991 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
5992 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
5993 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
5994 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
5995 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
5996 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
5997 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
5998 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
5999 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
6000 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
6001 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
6002 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
6003 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
6004 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
6005 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
6006 };
6007
6008 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
6009 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
6010 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6011 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
6012 (int) type);
6013
6014 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
6015 }
6016
6017 /* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
6018 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
6019
6020 static void
6021 output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
6022 const char *field_name,
6023 const std::vector<int> &inf_nums,
6024 int mi_only)
6025 {
6026 int is_mi = uiout->is_mi_like_p ();
6027
6028 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6029 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
6030 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
6031 return;
6032
6033 ui_out_emit_list list_emitter (uiout, field_name);
6034
6035 for (size_t i = 0; i < inf_nums.size (); i++)
6036 {
6037 if (is_mi)
6038 {
6039 char mi_group[10];
6040
6041 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf_nums[i]);
6042 uiout->field_string (NULL, mi_group);
6043 }
6044 else
6045 {
6046 if (i == 0)
6047 uiout->text (" inf ");
6048 else
6049 uiout->text (", ");
6050
6051 uiout->text (plongest (inf_nums[i]));
6052 }
6053 }
6054 }
6055
6056 /* Print B to gdb_stdout. If RAW_LOC, print raw breakpoint locations
6057 instead of going via breakpoint_ops::print_one. This makes "maint
6058 info breakpoints" show the software breakpoint locations of
6059 catchpoints, which are considered internal implementation
6060 detail. */
6061
6062 static void
6063 print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6064 struct bp_location *loc,
6065 int loc_number,
6066 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6067 int allflag, bool raw_loc)
6068 {
6069 struct command_line *l;
6070 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6071
6072 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6073 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6074 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6075 struct value_print_options opts;
6076
6077 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6078
6079 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6080 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6081 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6082 if (loc == NULL
6083 && (b->loc != NULL
6084 && (b->loc->next != NULL
6085 || !b->loc->enabled || b->loc->disabled_by_cond)))
6086 header_of_multiple = 1;
6087 if (loc == NULL)
6088 loc = b->loc;
6089
6090 annotate_record ();
6091
6092 /* 1 */
6093 annotate_field (0);
6094 if (part_of_multiple)
6095 uiout->field_fmt ("number", "%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6096 else
6097 uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
6098
6099 /* 2 */
6100 annotate_field (1);
6101 if (part_of_multiple)
6102 uiout->field_skip ("type");
6103 else
6104 uiout->field_string ("type", bptype_string (b->type));
6105
6106 /* 3 */
6107 annotate_field (2);
6108 if (part_of_multiple)
6109 uiout->field_skip ("disp");
6110 else
6111 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6112
6113 /* 4 */
6114 annotate_field (3);
6115 /* For locations that are disabled because of an invalid condition,
6116 display "N*" on CLI, where "*" refers to a footnote below the
6117 table. For MI, simply display a "N" without a footnote. */
6118 const char *N = (uiout->is_mi_like_p ()) ? "N" : "N*";
6119 if (part_of_multiple)
6120 uiout->field_string ("enabled", (loc->disabled_by_cond ? N
6121 : (loc->enabled ? "y" : "n")));
6122 else
6123 uiout->field_fmt ("enabled", "%c", bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6124
6125 /* 5 and 6 */
6126 if (!raw_loc && b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6127 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6128 else
6129 {
6130 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6131 {
6132 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6133
6134 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6135 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6136 is relatively readable). */
6137 if (opts.addressprint)
6138 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
6139 annotate_field (5);
6140 uiout->field_string ("what", w->exp_string);
6141 }
6142 else if (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b)
6143 || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b))
6144 {
6145 if (opts.addressprint)
6146 {
6147 annotate_field (4);
6148 if (header_of_multiple)
6149 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<MULTIPLE>",
6150 metadata_style.style ());
6151 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6152 uiout->field_string ("addr", "<PENDING>",
6153 metadata_style.style ());
6154 else
6155 uiout->field_core_addr ("addr",
6156 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6157 }
6158 annotate_field (5);
6159 if (!header_of_multiple)
6160 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6161 if (b->loc)
6162 *last_loc = b->loc;
6163 }
6164 }
6165
6166 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6167 {
6168 std::vector<int> inf_nums;
6169 int mi_only = 1;
6170
6171 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
6172 {
6173 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6174 inf_nums.push_back (inf->num);
6175 }
6176
6177 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6178 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6179 if (allflag
6180 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6181 && (program_spaces.size () > 1
6182 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6183 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6184 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6185 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6186 mi_only = 0;
6187 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_nums, mi_only);
6188 }
6189
6190 if (!part_of_multiple)
6191 {
6192 if (b->thread != -1)
6193 {
6194 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6195 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6196 uiout->text (" thread ");
6197 uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread);
6198 }
6199 else if (b->task != 0)
6200 {
6201 uiout->text (" task ");
6202 uiout->field_signed ("task", b->task);
6203 }
6204 }
6205
6206 uiout->text ("\n");
6207
6208 if (!part_of_multiple)
6209 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6210
6211 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6212 {
6213 annotate_field (6);
6214 uiout->text ("\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6215 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6216 the frame ID. */
6217 uiout->field_core_addr ("frame",
6218 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6219 uiout->text ("\n");
6220 }
6221
6222 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6223 {
6224 annotate_field (7);
6225 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6226 uiout->text ("\ttrace only if ");
6227 else
6228 uiout->text ("\tstop only if ");
6229 uiout->field_string ("cond", b->cond_string);
6230
6231 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6232 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6233 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6234 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6235 == condition_evaluation_target)
6236 {
6237 uiout->message (" (%pF evals)",
6238 string_field ("evaluated-by",
6239 bp_condition_evaluator (b)));
6240 }
6241 uiout->text ("\n");
6242 }
6243
6244 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6245 {
6246 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6247 uiout->text ("\tstop only in thread ");
6248 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6249 uiout->field_signed ("thread", b->thread);
6250 else
6251 {
6252 struct thread_info *thr = find_thread_global_id (b->thread);
6253
6254 uiout->field_string ("thread", print_thread_id (thr));
6255 }
6256 uiout->text ("\n");
6257 }
6258
6259 if (!part_of_multiple)
6260 {
6261 if (b->hit_count)
6262 {
6263 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6264 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6265 uiout->text ("\tcatchpoint");
6266 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6267 uiout->text ("\ttracepoint");
6268 else
6269 uiout->text ("\tbreakpoint");
6270 uiout->text (" already hit ");
6271 uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count);
6272 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6273 uiout->text (" time\n");
6274 else
6275 uiout->text (" times\n");
6276 }
6277 else
6278 {
6279 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6280 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6281 uiout->field_signed ("times", b->hit_count);
6282 }
6283 }
6284
6285 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6286 {
6287 annotate_field (8);
6288 uiout->message ("\tignore next %pF hits\n",
6289 signed_field ("ignore", b->ignore_count));
6290 }
6291
6292 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6293 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6294 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6295 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6296 {
6297 annotate_field (8);
6298 uiout->text ("\tdisable after ");
6299 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6300 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6301 if (b->ignore_count)
6302 uiout->text ("additional ");
6303 else
6304 uiout->text ("next ");
6305 uiout->field_signed ("enable", b->enable_count);
6306 uiout->text (" hits\n");
6307 }
6308
6309 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6310 {
6311 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6312
6313 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6314 {
6315 uiout->text ("\ttrace buffer usage ");
6316 uiout->field_signed ("traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6317 uiout->text (" bytes\n");
6318 }
6319 }
6320
6321 l = b->commands ? b->commands.get () : NULL;
6322 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6323 {
6324 annotate_field (9);
6325 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, "script");
6326 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6327 }
6328
6329 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6330 {
6331 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6332
6333 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6334 {
6335 annotate_field (10);
6336 uiout->text ("\tpass count ");
6337 uiout->field_signed ("pass", t->pass_count);
6338 uiout->text (" \n");
6339 }
6340
6341 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6342 pending. */
6343 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6344 {
6345 annotate_field (11);
6346
6347 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6348 uiout->field_string ("installed",
6349 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6350 else
6351 {
6352 if (loc->inserted)
6353 uiout->text ("\t");
6354 else
6355 uiout->text ("\tnot ");
6356 uiout->text ("installed on target\n");
6357 }
6358 }
6359 }
6360
6361 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && !part_of_multiple)
6362 {
6363 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6364 {
6365 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6366
6367 uiout->field_string ("original-location", w->exp_string);
6368 }
6369 else if (b->location != NULL
6370 && event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()) != NULL)
6371 uiout->field_string ("original-location",
6372 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
6373 }
6374 }
6375
6376 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6377
6378 bool fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally = false;
6379
6380 static void
6381 print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6382 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6383 int allflag)
6384 {
6385 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6386 bool use_fixed_output
6387 = (uiout->test_flags (fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output)
6388 || fix_multi_location_breakpoint_output_globally);
6389
6390 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> bkpt_tuple_emitter (gdb::in_place, uiout, "bkpt");
6391 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag, false);
6392
6393 /* The mi2 broken format: the main breakpoint tuple ends here, the locations
6394 are outside. */
6395 if (!use_fixed_output)
6396 bkpt_tuple_emitter.reset ();
6397
6398 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6399 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6400 locations, if any. */
6401 if (b->ops == NULL
6402 || b->ops->print_one == NULL
6403 || allflag)
6404 {
6405 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6406 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6407 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6408 situation.
6409
6410 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6411 internally, that's not a property exposed to users.
6412
6413 Likewise, while catchpoints may be implemented with
6414 breakpoints (e.g., catch throw), that's not a property
6415 exposed to users. We do however display the internal
6416 breakpoint locations with "maint info breakpoints". */
6417 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6418 && (!is_catchpoint (b) || is_exception_catchpoint (b)
6419 || is_ada_exception_catchpoint (b))
6420 && (allflag
6421 || (b->loc && (b->loc->next
6422 || !b->loc->enabled
6423 || b->loc->disabled_by_cond))))
6424 {
6425 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_list> locations_list;
6426
6427 /* For MI version <= 2, keep the behavior where GDB outputs an invalid
6428 MI record. For later versions, place breakpoint locations in a
6429 list. */
6430 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p () && use_fixed_output)
6431 locations_list.emplace (uiout, "locations");
6432
6433 int n = 1;
6434 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
6435 {
6436 ui_out_emit_tuple loc_tuple_emitter (uiout, NULL);
6437 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc,
6438 allflag, allflag);
6439 n++;
6440 }
6441 }
6442 }
6443 }
6444
6445 static int
6446 breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6447 {
6448 int print_address_bits = 0;
6449
6450 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have an
6451 address to print. */
6452 if (is_no_memory_software_watchpoint (b))
6453 return 0;
6454
6455 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
6456 {
6457 int addr_bit;
6458
6459 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6460 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6461 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6462 }
6463
6464 return print_address_bits;
6465 }
6466
6467 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6468
6469 void
6470 print_breakpoint (breakpoint *b)
6471 {
6472 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6473 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6474 }
6475
6476 /* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6477 internal or momentary. */
6478
6479 int
6480 user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6481 {
6482 return b->number > 0;
6483 }
6484
6485 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6486
6487 int
6488 pending_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6489 {
6490 return b->loc == NULL;
6491 }
6492
6493 /* Print information on breakpoints (including watchpoints and tracepoints).
6494
6495 If non-NULL, BP_NUM_LIST is a list of numbers and number ranges as
6496 understood by number_or_range_parser. Only breakpoints included in this
6497 list are then printed.
6498
6499 If SHOW_INTERNAL is true, print internal breakpoints.
6500
6501 If FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6502 ones for which it returns true.
6503
6504 Return the total number of breakpoints listed. */
6505
6506 static int
6507 breakpoint_1 (const char *bp_num_list, bool show_internal,
6508 bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6509 {
6510 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6511 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6512 struct value_print_options opts;
6513 int print_address_bits = 0;
6514 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6515 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6516 bool has_disabled_by_cond_location = false;
6517
6518 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6519
6520 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6521 required for address fields. */
6522 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6523 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
6524 {
6525 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6526 if (filter && !filter (b))
6527 continue;
6528
6529 /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6530 accept. Skip the others. */
6531 if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0')
6532 {
6533 if (show_internal && parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b->number)
6534 continue;
6535 if (!show_internal && !number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b->number))
6536 continue;
6537 }
6538
6539 if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6540 {
6541 int addr_bit, type_len;
6542
6543 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6544 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6545 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6546
6547 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6548 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6549 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6550
6551 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6552 }
6553 }
6554
6555 {
6556 ui_out_emit_table table_emitter (uiout,
6557 opts.addressprint ? 6 : 5,
6558 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6559 "BreakpointTable");
6560
6561 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6562 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6563 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6564 annotate_field (0);
6565 uiout->table_header (7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6566 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6567 annotate_field (1);
6568 uiout->table_header (print_type_col_width, ui_left, "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6569 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6570 annotate_field (2);
6571 uiout->table_header (4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6572 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6573 annotate_field (3);
6574 uiout->table_header (3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6575 if (opts.addressprint)
6576 {
6577 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6578 annotate_field (4);
6579 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6580 uiout->table_header (10, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6581 else
6582 uiout->table_header (18, ui_left, "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6583 }
6584 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6585 annotate_field (5);
6586 uiout->table_header (40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6587 uiout->table_body ();
6588 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6589 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6590
6591 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
6592 {
6593 QUIT;
6594 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6595 if (filter && !filter (b))
6596 continue;
6597
6598 /* If we have a BP_NUM_LIST string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6599 accept. Skip the others. */
6600
6601 if (bp_num_list != NULL && *bp_num_list != '\0')
6602 {
6603 if (show_internal) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6604 {
6605 if (parse_and_eval_long (bp_num_list) != b->number)
6606 continue;
6607 }
6608 else /* all others */
6609 {
6610 if (!number_is_in_list (bp_num_list, b->number))
6611 continue;
6612 }
6613 }
6614 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6615 show_internal is set. */
6616 if (show_internal || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6617 {
6618 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, show_internal);
6619 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
6620 if (loc->disabled_by_cond)
6621 has_disabled_by_cond_location = true;
6622 }
6623 }
6624 }
6625
6626 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6627 {
6628 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6629 empty list. */
6630 if (!filter)
6631 {
6632 if (bp_num_list == NULL || *bp_num_list == '\0')
6633 uiout->message ("No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6634 else
6635 uiout->message ("No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6636 bp_num_list);
6637 }
6638 }
6639 else
6640 {
6641 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6642 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6643
6644 if (has_disabled_by_cond_location && !uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
6645 uiout->message (_("(*): Breakpoint condition is invalid at this "
6646 "location.\n"));
6647 }
6648
6649 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6650 there have been breakpoints? */
6651 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6652
6653 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6654 }
6655
6656 /* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6657 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6658
6659 static void
6660 default_collect_info (void)
6661 {
6662 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6663
6664 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6665 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6666 not wanted. */
6667 if (!*default_collect)
6668 return;
6669
6670 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6671 actions. */
6672 uiout->text ("default collect ");
6673 uiout->field_string ("default-collect", default_collect);
6674 uiout->text (" \n");
6675 }
6676
6677 static void
6678 info_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6679 {
6680 breakpoint_1 (args, false, NULL);
6681
6682 default_collect_info ();
6683 }
6684
6685 static void
6686 info_watchpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
6687 {
6688 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_watchpoint);
6689 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6690
6691 if (num_printed == 0)
6692 {
6693 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6694 uiout->message ("No watchpoints.\n");
6695 else
6696 uiout->message ("No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6697 }
6698 }
6699
6700 static void
6701 maintenance_info_breakpoints (const char *args, int from_tty)
6702 {
6703 breakpoint_1 (args, true, NULL);
6704
6705 default_collect_info ();
6706 }
6707
6708 static int
6709 breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6710 struct program_space *pspace,
6711 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6712 {
6713 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
6714 {
6715 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6716 && bl->address == pc
6717 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6718 return 1;
6719 }
6720 return 0;
6721 }
6722
6723 /* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6724 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6725 address spaces. */
6726
6727 static void
6728 describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6729 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6730 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6731 {
6732 int others = 0;
6733
6734 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
6735 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6736 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6737
6738 if (others > 0)
6739 {
6740 if (others == 1)
6741 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6742 else /* if (others == ???) */
6743 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6744 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
6745 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6746 {
6747 others--;
6748 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6749 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6750 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6751 else if (b->thread != -1)
6752 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6753 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6754 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6755 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6756 ? " (disabled)"
6757 : ""),
6758 (others > 1) ? ","
6759 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6760 }
6761 current_uiout->message (_("also set at pc %ps.\n"),
6762 styled_string (address_style.style (),
6763 paddress (gdbarch, pc)));
6764 }
6765 }
6766 \f
6767
6768 /* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of LOC.
6769 For some breakpoint types, the locations' address members are
6770 irrelevant and it makes no sense to attempt to compare them to
6771 other addresses (or use them for any other purpose either).
6772
6773 More specifically, software watchpoints and catchpoints that are
6774 not backed by breakpoints always have a zero valued location
6775 address and we don't want to mark breakpoints of any of these types
6776 to be a duplicate of an actual breakpoint location at address
6777 zero. */
6778
6779 static bool
6780 bl_address_is_meaningful (bp_location *loc)
6781 {
6782 return loc->loc_type != bp_loc_other;
6783 }
6784
6785 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6786 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6787
6788 static int
6789 watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6790 struct bp_location *loc2)
6791 {
6792 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6793 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6794
6795 /* Both of them must exist. */
6796 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6797 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6798
6799 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6800 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6801 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6802 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6803 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6804 other watchpoint. */
6805 if ((w1->cond_exp
6806 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6807 loc1->length,
6808 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6809 w1->cond_exp.get ()))
6810 || (w2->cond_exp
6811 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6812 loc2->length,
6813 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6814 w2->cond_exp.get ())))
6815 return 0;
6816
6817 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6818 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6819 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6820 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6821 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6822 become hw_access locations later. */
6823 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6824 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6825 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6826 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6827 }
6828
6829 /* See breakpoint.h. */
6830
6831 int
6832 breakpoint_address_match (const address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6833 const address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6834 {
6835 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6836 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6837 && addr1 == addr2);
6838 }
6839
6840 /* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6841 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6842 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6843 space doesn't really matter. */
6844
6845 static int
6846 breakpoint_address_match_range (const address_space *aspace1,
6847 CORE_ADDR addr1,
6848 int len1, const address_space *aspace2,
6849 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6850 {
6851 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6852 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6853 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6854 }
6855
6856 /* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6857 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6858 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6859 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6860
6861 static int
6862 breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6863 const address_space *aspace,
6864 CORE_ADDR addr)
6865 {
6866 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6867 aspace, addr)
6868 || (bl->length
6869 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6870 bl->address, bl->length,
6871 aspace, addr)));
6872 }
6873
6874 /* Returns true if the [ADDR,ADDR+LEN) range in ASPACE overlaps
6875 breakpoint BL. BL may be a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a
6876 match happens only if ASPACE matches the breakpoint's address
6877 space. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address space
6878 doesn't really matter. */
6879
6880 static int
6881 breakpoint_location_address_range_overlap (struct bp_location *bl,
6882 const address_space *aspace,
6883 CORE_ADDR addr, int len)
6884 {
6885 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6886 || bl->pspace->aspace == aspace)
6887 {
6888 int bl_len = bl->length != 0 ? bl->length : 1;
6889
6890 if (mem_ranges_overlap (addr, len, bl->address, bl_len))
6891 return 1;
6892 }
6893 return 0;
6894 }
6895
6896 /* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6897 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6898 true, otherwise returns false. */
6899
6900 static int
6901 tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6902 struct bp_location *loc2)
6903 {
6904 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6905 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6906 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6907 different locations. */
6908 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6909 else
6910 return 0;
6911 }
6912
6913 /* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6914 (bl_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent
6915 the same location. If SW_HW_BPS_MATCH is true, then software
6916 breakpoint locations and hardware breakpoint locations match,
6917 otherwise they don't. */
6918
6919 static int
6920 breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6921 struct bp_location *loc2,
6922 bool sw_hw_bps_match)
6923 {
6924 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
6925
6926 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
6927 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
6928 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
6929
6930 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
6931 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
6932
6933 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
6934 return 0;
6935 else if (hw_point1)
6936 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6937 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6938 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
6939 else
6940 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged
6941 breakpoints. Keep this in sync with
6942 bp_location_is_less_than. */
6943 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
6944 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
6945 && (loc1->loc_type == loc2->loc_type || sw_hw_bps_match)
6946 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6947 }
6948
6949 static void
6950 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
6951 int bnum, int have_bnum)
6952 {
6953 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
6954 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
6955 char astr1[64];
6956 char astr2[64];
6957
6958 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
6959 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
6960 if (have_bnum)
6961 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
6962 bnum, astr1, astr2);
6963 else
6964 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
6965 }
6966
6967 /* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
6968 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
6969 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
6970 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
6971
6972 static CORE_ADDR
6973 adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6974 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
6975 {
6976 if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
6977 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
6978 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
6979 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
6980 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
6981 {
6982 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
6983 have their addresses modified. */
6984 return bpaddr;
6985 }
6986 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
6987 {
6988 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
6989 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
6990 applies to this address, then it should have already been
6991 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
6992 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
6993 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
6994 return bpaddr;
6995 }
6996 else
6997 {
6998 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr = bpaddr;
6999
7000 if (gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
7001 {
7002 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
7003 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
7004 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
7005 }
7006
7007 adjusted_bpaddr = address_significant (gdbarch, adjusted_bpaddr);
7008
7009 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
7010 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
7011 is required. */
7012 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
7013 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
7014
7015 return adjusted_bpaddr;
7016 }
7017 }
7018
7019 static bp_loc_type
7020 bp_location_from_bp_type (bptype type)
7021 {
7022 switch (type)
7023 {
7024 case bp_breakpoint:
7025 case bp_single_step:
7026 case bp_until:
7027 case bp_finish:
7028 case bp_longjmp:
7029 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7030 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
7031 case bp_exception:
7032 case bp_exception_resume:
7033 case bp_step_resume:
7034 case bp_hp_step_resume:
7035 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7036 case bp_call_dummy:
7037 case bp_std_terminate:
7038 case bp_shlib_event:
7039 case bp_thread_event:
7040 case bp_overlay_event:
7041 case bp_jit_event:
7042 case bp_longjmp_master:
7043 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7044 case bp_exception_master:
7045 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7046 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7047 case bp_dprintf:
7048 return bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7049 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7050 return bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7051 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7052 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7053 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7054 return bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7055 case bp_watchpoint:
7056 case bp_catchpoint:
7057 case bp_tracepoint:
7058 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7059 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7060 return bp_loc_other;
7061 default:
7062 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7063 }
7064 }
7065
7066 bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner, bp_loc_type type)
7067 {
7068 this->owner = owner;
7069 this->cond_bytecode = NULL;
7070 this->shlib_disabled = 0;
7071 this->enabled = 1;
7072 this->disabled_by_cond = false;
7073
7074 this->loc_type = type;
7075
7076 if (this->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
7077 || this->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
7078 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (this);
7079
7080 incref ();
7081 }
7082
7083 bp_location::bp_location (breakpoint *owner)
7084 : bp_location::bp_location (owner,
7085 bp_location_from_bp_type (owner->type))
7086 {
7087 }
7088
7089 /* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7090
7091 static struct bp_location *
7092 allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7093 {
7094 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7095 }
7096
7097 /* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7098 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7099
7100 static void
7101 decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7102 {
7103 bp_location_ref_policy::decref (*blp);
7104 *blp = NULL;
7105 }
7106
7107 /* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7108
7109 static breakpoint *
7110 add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&b)
7111 {
7112 struct breakpoint *b1;
7113 struct breakpoint *result = b.get ();
7114
7115 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7116 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7117
7118 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7119 if (b1 == 0)
7120 breakpoint_chain = b.release ();
7121 else
7122 {
7123 while (b1->next)
7124 b1 = b1->next;
7125 b1->next = b.release ();
7126 }
7127
7128 return result;
7129 }
7130
7131 /* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7132
7133 static void
7134 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7135 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7136 enum bptype bptype,
7137 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7138 {
7139 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7140
7141 b->ops = ops;
7142 b->type = bptype;
7143 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7144 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7145 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7146 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7147 }
7148
7149 /* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7150 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7151
7152 static struct breakpoint *
7153 set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7154 enum bptype bptype,
7155 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7156 {
7157 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7158
7159 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7160 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7161 }
7162
7163 /* Initialize loc->function_name. */
7164
7165 static void
7166 set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc)
7167 {
7168 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7169
7170 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7171 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7172 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7173 {
7174 const char *function_name;
7175
7176 if (loc->msymbol != NULL
7177 && (MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_text_gnu_ifunc
7178 || MSYMBOL_TYPE (loc->msymbol) == mst_data_gnu_ifunc))
7179 {
7180 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7181
7182 function_name = loc->msymbol->linkage_name ();
7183
7184 if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7185 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7186 {
7187 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7188 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7189 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7190 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7191 breakpoint. */
7192 loc->related_address = loc->address;
7193 }
7194 }
7195 else
7196 find_pc_partial_function (loc->address, &function_name, NULL, NULL);
7197
7198 if (function_name)
7199 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7200 }
7201 }
7202
7203 /* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7204 struct gdbarch *
7205 get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7206 {
7207 if (sal.section)
7208 return sal.section->objfile->arch ();
7209 if (sal.symtab)
7210 return SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab)->arch ();
7211
7212 return NULL;
7213 }
7214
7215 /* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7216 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7217 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7218
7219 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7220 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7221 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7222
7223 static void
7224 init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7225 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7226 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7227 {
7228 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7229
7230 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7231
7232 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7233 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7234
7235 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7236 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7237 program space. */
7238 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7239 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7240 }
7241
7242 /* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7243 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7244 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7245 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7246 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7247 is also returned as the value of this function.
7248
7249 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7250 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7251 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7252 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7253 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7254 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7255 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7256
7257 struct breakpoint *
7258 set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7259 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7260 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7261 {
7262 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (bptype);
7263
7264 init_raw_breakpoint (b.get (), gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7265 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
7266 }
7267
7268 /* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7269 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7270 initiated the operation. */
7271
7272 void
7273 set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7274 {
7275 int thread = tp->global_num;
7276
7277 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7278 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7279 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7280 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7281 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7282 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7283 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7284 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7285 {
7286 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7287 struct breakpoint *clone;
7288
7289 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7290 after their removal. */
7291 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7292 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7293 clone->thread = thread;
7294 }
7295
7296 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7297 }
7298
7299 /* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7300 void
7301 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7302 {
7303 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7304 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7305 {
7306 if (b->thread == thread)
7307 delete_breakpoint (b);
7308 }
7309 }
7310
7311 void
7312 delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7313 {
7314 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7315 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7316 {
7317 if (b->thread == thread)
7318 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7319 }
7320 }
7321
7322 /* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7323 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7324 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7325 breakpoints. */
7326
7327 struct breakpoint *
7328 set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7329 {
7330 breakpoint *retval = nullptr;
7331
7332 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
7333 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7334 {
7335 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7336
7337 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7338 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7339 1);
7340 new_b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
7341
7342 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7343
7344 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7345 if (retval == NULL)
7346 retval = new_b;
7347 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7348 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7349 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7350 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7351 }
7352
7353 return retval;
7354 }
7355
7356 /* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7357 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7358 stack.
7359
7360 If the unwind fails then there is not sufficient information to discard
7361 dummy frames. In this case, elide the clean up and the dummy frames will
7362 be cleaned up next time this function is called from a location where
7363 unwinding is possible. */
7364
7365 void
7366 check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7367 {
7368 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7369
7370 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7371 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->global_num)
7372 {
7373 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7374
7375 /* Find the bp_call_dummy breakpoint in the list of breakpoints
7376 chained off b->related_breakpoint. */
7377 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7378 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7379
7380 /* If there was no bp_call_dummy breakpoint then there's nothing
7381 more to do. Or, if the dummy frame associated with the
7382 bp_call_dummy is still on the stack then we need to leave this
7383 bp_call_dummy in place. */
7384 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7385 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7386 continue;
7387
7388 /* We didn't find the dummy frame on the stack, this could be
7389 because we have longjmp'd to a stack frame that is previous to
7390 the dummy frame, or it could be because the stack unwind is
7391 broken at some point between the longjmp frame and the dummy
7392 frame.
7393
7394 Next we figure out why the stack unwind stopped. If it looks
7395 like the unwind is complete then we assume the dummy frame has
7396 been jumped over, however, if the unwind stopped for an
7397 unexpected reason then we assume the stack unwind is currently
7398 broken, and that we will (eventually) return to the dummy
7399 frame.
7400
7401 It might be tempting to consider using frame_id_inner here, but
7402 that is not safe. There is no guarantee that the stack frames
7403 we are looking at here are even on the same stack as the
7404 original dummy frame, hence frame_id_inner can't be used. See
7405 the comments on frame_id_inner for more details. */
7406 bool unwind_finished_unexpectedly = false;
7407 for (struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame (); fi != nullptr; )
7408 {
7409 struct frame_info *prev = get_prev_frame (fi);
7410 if (prev == nullptr)
7411 {
7412 /* FI is the last stack frame. Why did this frame not
7413 unwind further? */
7414 auto stop_reason = get_frame_unwind_stop_reason (fi);
7415 if (stop_reason != UNWIND_NO_REASON
7416 && stop_reason != UNWIND_OUTERMOST)
7417 unwind_finished_unexpectedly = true;
7418 }
7419 fi = prev;
7420 }
7421 if (unwind_finished_unexpectedly)
7422 continue;
7423
7424 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp);
7425
7426 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7427 {
7428 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7429 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7430 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7431 }
7432 delete_breakpoint (b);
7433 }
7434 }
7435
7436 void
7437 enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7438 {
7439 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
7440 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7441 {
7442 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7443 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7444 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7445 }
7446 }
7447
7448 void
7449 disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7450 {
7451 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
7452 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7453 {
7454 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7455 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7456 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7457 }
7458 }
7459
7460 /* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7461 master breakpoint. */
7462 void
7463 set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7464 {
7465 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7466 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7467 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7468 {
7469 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7470 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7471 }
7472 }
7473
7474 /* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7475 void
7476 delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7477 {
7478 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7479 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7480 delete_breakpoint (b);
7481 }
7482
7483 struct breakpoint *
7484 create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7485 {
7486 struct breakpoint *b;
7487
7488 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7489 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7490
7491 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7492 /* location has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7493 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
7494
7495 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7496
7497 return b;
7498 }
7499
7500 struct lang_and_radix
7501 {
7502 enum language lang;
7503 int radix;
7504 };
7505
7506 /* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7507
7508 struct breakpoint *
7509 create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7510 {
7511 return create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7512 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7513 }
7514
7515 /* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7516
7517 void
7518 remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7519 {
7520 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7521 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7522 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7523 delete_breakpoint (b);
7524 }
7525
7526 void
7527 remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7528 {
7529 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7530 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7531 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7532 delete_breakpoint (b);
7533 }
7534
7535 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7536
7537 void
7538 remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7539 {
7540 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
7541 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7542 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7543 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7544 }
7545
7546 /* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7547 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7548 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7549
7550 static struct breakpoint *
7551 create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7552 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7553 {
7554 struct breakpoint *b;
7555
7556 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7557 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7558 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7559 return b;
7560 }
7561
7562 struct breakpoint *
7563 create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7564 {
7565 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7566 }
7567
7568 /* See breakpoint.h. */
7569
7570 struct breakpoint *
7571 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7572 {
7573 struct breakpoint *b;
7574
7575 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7576 locations. */
7577 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7578 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7579 {
7580 delete_breakpoint (b);
7581 return NULL;
7582 }
7583 return b;
7584 }
7585
7586 /* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7587 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7588
7589 void
7590 disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7591 {
7592 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
7593 {
7594 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7595 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7596
7597 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7598 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7599 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7600 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7601 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7602 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7603 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7604 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7605 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7606 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7607 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7608 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7609 )
7610 {
7611 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7612 }
7613 }
7614 }
7615
7616 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7617 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7618 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7619
7620 static void
7621 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7622 {
7623 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7624
7625 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
7626 {
7627 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7628 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7629
7630 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7631 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7632 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7633 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7634 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7635 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7636 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7637 || is_tracepoint (b))
7638 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7639 {
7640 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7641 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7642 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7643 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7644 loc->inserted = 0;
7645
7646 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7647 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7648
7649 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7650 {
7651 target_terminal::ours_for_output ();
7652 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7653 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7654 solib->so_name);
7655 }
7656 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7657 }
7658 }
7659 }
7660
7661 /* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7662 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7663 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7664
7665 static void
7666 disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7667 {
7668 if (objfile == NULL)
7669 return;
7670
7671 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7672 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7673 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7674 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7675 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7676 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7677 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7678 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7679 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7680 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7681 main objfile). */
7682 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7683 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7684 return;
7685
7686 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
7687 {
7688 int bp_modified = 0;
7689
7690 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7691 continue;
7692
7693 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
7694 {
7695 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7696
7697 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7698 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7699 continue;
7700
7701 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7702 continue;
7703
7704 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7705 continue;
7706
7707 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7708 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7709 continue;
7710
7711 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7712 {
7713 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7714 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7715 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7716 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7717 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7718 unmapped. */
7719
7720 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7721
7722 bp_modified = 1;
7723 }
7724 }
7725
7726 if (bp_modified)
7727 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
7728 }
7729 }
7730
7731 /* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7732
7733 /* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7734 catchpoint. A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points
7735 to CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7736
7737 struct fork_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7738 {
7739 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7740 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7741 catchpoint has triggered. */
7742 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7743 };
7744
7745 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7746 catchpoints. */
7747
7748 static int
7749 insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7750 {
7751 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7752 }
7753
7754 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7755 catchpoints. */
7756
7757 static int
7758 remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7759 {
7760 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7761 }
7762
7763 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7764 catchpoints. */
7765
7766 static int
7767 breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7768 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7769 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7770 {
7771 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7772
7773 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7774 return 0;
7775
7776 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7777 return 1;
7778 }
7779
7780 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7781 catchpoints. */
7782
7783 static enum print_stop_action
7784 print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7785 {
7786 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7787 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7788 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7789
7790 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7791 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7792 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7793 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7794 else
7795 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7796 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7797 {
7798 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7799 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7800 }
7801 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
7802 uiout->text (" (forked process ");
7803 uiout->field_signed ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7804 uiout->text ("), ");
7805 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7806 }
7807
7808 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7809 catchpoints. */
7810
7811 static void
7812 print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7813 {
7814 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7815 struct value_print_options opts;
7816 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7817
7818 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7819
7820 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7821 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7822 readable). */
7823 if (opts.addressprint)
7824 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7825 annotate_field (5);
7826 uiout->text ("fork");
7827 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7828 {
7829 uiout->text (", process ");
7830 uiout->field_signed ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7831 uiout->spaces (1);
7832 }
7833
7834 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7835 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "fork");
7836 }
7837
7838 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7839 catchpoints. */
7840
7841 static void
7842 print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7843 {
7844 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7845 }
7846
7847 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7848 catchpoints. */
7849
7850 static void
7851 print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7852 {
7853 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7854 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7855 }
7856
7857 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7858
7859 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7860
7861 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7862 catchpoints. */
7863
7864 static int
7865 insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
7866 {
7867 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7868 }
7869
7870 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7871 catchpoints. */
7872
7873 static int
7874 remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
7875 {
7876 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
7877 }
7878
7879 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7880 catchpoints. */
7881
7882 static int
7883 breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7884 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7885 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7886 {
7887 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7888
7889 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
7890 return 0;
7891
7892 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7893 return 1;
7894 }
7895
7896 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7897 catchpoints. */
7898
7899 static enum print_stop_action
7900 print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
7901 {
7902 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7903 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7904 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7905
7906 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7907 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
7908 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7909 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
7910 else
7911 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
7912 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7913 {
7914 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
7915 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7916 }
7917 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
7918 uiout->text (" (vforked process ");
7919 uiout->field_signed ("newpid", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7920 uiout->text ("), ");
7921 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7922 }
7923
7924 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7925 catchpoints. */
7926
7927 static void
7928 print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7929 {
7930 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7931 struct value_print_options opts;
7932 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7933
7934 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7935 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7936 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7937 readable). */
7938 if (opts.addressprint)
7939 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
7940 annotate_field (5);
7941 uiout->text ("vfork");
7942 if (c->forked_inferior_pid != null_ptid)
7943 {
7944 uiout->text (", process ");
7945 uiout->field_signed ("what", c->forked_inferior_pid.pid ());
7946 uiout->spaces (1);
7947 }
7948
7949 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
7950 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "vfork");
7951 }
7952
7953 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7954 catchpoints. */
7955
7956 static void
7957 print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
7958 {
7959 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
7960 }
7961
7962 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
7963 catchpoints. */
7964
7965 static void
7966 print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7967 {
7968 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
7969 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7970 }
7971
7972 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
7973
7974 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
7975
7976 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
7977 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7978 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7979
7980 struct solib_catchpoint : public breakpoint
7981 {
7982 ~solib_catchpoint () override;
7983
7984 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
7985 bool is_load;
7986
7987 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
7988 REGEX is non-NULL. */
7989 char *regex;
7990 std::unique_ptr<compiled_regex> compiled;
7991 };
7992
7993 solib_catchpoint::~solib_catchpoint ()
7994 {
7995 xfree (this->regex);
7996 }
7997
7998 static int
7999 insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8000 {
8001 return 0;
8002 }
8003
8004 static int
8005 remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8006 {
8007 return 0;
8008 }
8009
8010 static int
8011 breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
8012 const address_space *aspace,
8013 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8014 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8015 {
8016 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8017
8018 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
8019 return 1;
8020
8021 for (breakpoint *other : all_breakpoints ())
8022 {
8023 if (other == bl->owner)
8024 continue;
8025
8026 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
8027 continue;
8028
8029 if (self->pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->pspace)
8030 continue;
8031
8032 for (bp_location *other_bl : other->locations ())
8033 {
8034 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
8035 return 1;
8036 }
8037 }
8038
8039 return 0;
8040 }
8041
8042 static void
8043 check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
8044 {
8045 struct solib_catchpoint *self
8046 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8047
8048 if (self->is_load)
8049 {
8050 for (so_list *iter : current_program_space->added_solibs)
8051 {
8052 if (!self->regex
8053 || self->compiled->exec (iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8054 return;
8055 }
8056 }
8057 else
8058 {
8059 for (const std::string &iter : current_program_space->deleted_solibs)
8060 {
8061 if (!self->regex
8062 || self->compiled->exec (iter.c_str (), 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8063 return;
8064 }
8065 }
8066
8067 bs->stop = 0;
8068 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8069 }
8070
8071 static enum print_stop_action
8072 print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8073 {
8074 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8075 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8076
8077 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8078 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8079 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8080 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8081 else
8082 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8083 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
8084 uiout->text ("\n");
8085 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8086 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8087 print_solib_event (1);
8088 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8089 }
8090
8091 static void
8092 print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8093 {
8094 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8095 struct value_print_options opts;
8096 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8097
8098 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8099 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8100 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8101 readable). */
8102 if (opts.addressprint)
8103 {
8104 annotate_field (4);
8105 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8106 }
8107
8108 std::string msg;
8109 annotate_field (5);
8110 if (self->is_load)
8111 {
8112 if (self->regex)
8113 msg = string_printf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8114 else
8115 msg = _("load of library");
8116 }
8117 else
8118 {
8119 if (self->regex)
8120 msg = string_printf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8121 else
8122 msg = _("unload of library");
8123 }
8124 uiout->field_string ("what", msg);
8125
8126 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8127 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8128 }
8129
8130 static void
8131 print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8132 {
8133 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8134
8135 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8136 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8137 }
8138
8139 static void
8140 print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8141 {
8142 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8143
8144 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8145 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8146 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8147 if (self->regex)
8148 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8149 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8150 }
8151
8152 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8153
8154 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8155
8156 void
8157 add_solib_catchpoint (const char *arg, bool is_load, bool is_temp, bool enabled)
8158 {
8159 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8160
8161 if (!arg)
8162 arg = "";
8163 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8164
8165 std::unique_ptr<solib_catchpoint> c (new solib_catchpoint ());
8166
8167 if (*arg != '\0')
8168 {
8169 c->compiled.reset (new compiled_regex (arg, REG_NOSUB,
8170 _("Invalid regexp")));
8171 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8172 }
8173
8174 c->is_load = is_load;
8175 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8176 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8177
8178 c->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8179
8180 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8181 }
8182
8183 /* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8184 "catch unload". */
8185
8186 static void
8187 catch_load_or_unload (const char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8188 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8189 {
8190 const int enabled = 1;
8191 bool temp = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8192
8193 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, temp, enabled);
8194 }
8195
8196 static void
8197 catch_load_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8198 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8199 {
8200 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8201 }
8202
8203 static void
8204 catch_unload_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
8205 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8206 {
8207 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8208 }
8209
8210 /* See breakpoint.h. */
8211
8212 void
8213 init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8214 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, bool temp,
8215 const char *cond_string,
8216 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8217 {
8218 symtab_and_line sal;
8219 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8220
8221 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8222
8223 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8224 b->disposition = temp ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8225 }
8226
8227 void
8228 install_breakpoint (int internal, std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> &&arg, int update_gll)
8229 {
8230 breakpoint *b = add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (arg));
8231 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8232 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8233 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8234 if (!internal)
8235 mention (b);
8236 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
8237
8238 if (update_gll)
8239 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8240 }
8241
8242 static void
8243 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8244 bool temp, const char *cond_string,
8245 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8246 {
8247 std::unique_ptr<fork_catchpoint> c (new fork_catchpoint ());
8248
8249 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, temp, cond_string, ops);
8250
8251 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8252
8253 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
8254 }
8255
8256 /* Exec catchpoints. */
8257
8258 /* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8259 A breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8260 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8261
8262 struct exec_catchpoint : public breakpoint
8263 {
8264 ~exec_catchpoint () override;
8265
8266 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8267 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8268 triggered. */
8269 char *exec_pathname;
8270 };
8271
8272 /* Exec catchpoint destructor. */
8273
8274 exec_catchpoint::~exec_catchpoint ()
8275 {
8276 xfree (this->exec_pathname);
8277 }
8278
8279 static int
8280 insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8281 {
8282 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8283 }
8284
8285 static int
8286 remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
8287 {
8288 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (inferior_ptid.pid ());
8289 }
8290
8291 static int
8292 breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8293 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8294 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8295 {
8296 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8297
8298 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8299 return 0;
8300
8301 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8302 return 1;
8303 }
8304
8305 static enum print_stop_action
8306 print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8307 {
8308 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8309 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8310 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8311
8312 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8313 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
8314 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8315 uiout->text ("Temporary catchpoint ");
8316 else
8317 uiout->text ("Catchpoint ");
8318 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8319 {
8320 uiout->field_string ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8321 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8322 }
8323 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
8324 uiout->text (" (exec'd ");
8325 uiout->field_string ("new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8326 uiout->text ("), ");
8327
8328 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8329 }
8330
8331 static void
8332 print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8333 {
8334 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8335 struct value_print_options opts;
8336 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8337
8338 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8339
8340 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8341 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8342 is relatively readable). */
8343 if (opts.addressprint)
8344 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
8345 annotate_field (5);
8346 uiout->text ("exec");
8347 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8348 {
8349 uiout->text (", program \"");
8350 uiout->field_string ("what", c->exec_pathname);
8351 uiout->text ("\" ");
8352 }
8353
8354 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
8355 uiout->field_string ("catch-type", "exec");
8356 }
8357
8358 static void
8359 print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8360 {
8361 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8362 }
8363
8364 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8365 catchpoints. */
8366
8367 static void
8368 print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8369 {
8370 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8371 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8372 }
8373
8374 static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8375
8376 static int
8377 hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8378 {
8379 int i = 0;
8380
8381 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8382 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8383 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
8384 {
8385 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8386 one register. */
8387 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8388 }
8389
8390 return i;
8391 }
8392
8393 /* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
8394 watchpoint. */
8395
8396 static int
8397 hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
8398 {
8399 int i = 0;
8400
8401 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8402 return 0;
8403
8404 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
8405 {
8406 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
8407 one register. */
8408 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8409 }
8410
8411 return i;
8412 }
8413
8414 /* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
8415 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
8416 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
8417 types _not_ TYPE. */
8418
8419 static int
8420 hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
8421 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
8422 {
8423 int i = 0;
8424
8425 *other_type_used = 0;
8426 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8427 {
8428 if (b == except)
8429 continue;
8430 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
8431 continue;
8432
8433 if (b->type == type)
8434 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
8435 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
8436 *other_type_used = 1;
8437 }
8438
8439 return i;
8440 }
8441
8442 void
8443 disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
8444 {
8445 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8446 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8447 {
8448 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
8449 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8450 }
8451 }
8452
8453 void
8454 enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
8455 {
8456 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8457 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
8458 {
8459 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8460 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8461 }
8462 }
8463
8464 void
8465 disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
8466 {
8467 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
8468 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8469 }
8470
8471 void
8472 enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
8473 {
8474 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
8475 breakpoint_re_set ();
8476 }
8477
8478 /* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
8479 locations. */
8480
8481 static struct breakpoint *
8482 new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
8483 {
8484 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b (new breakpoint ());
8485
8486 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, bp_single_step,
8487 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8488
8489 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8490 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
8491
8492 b->thread = thread;
8493 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
8494
8495 return add_to_breakpoint_chain (std::move (b));
8496 }
8497
8498 /* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
8499 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
8500 frame. */
8501
8502 breakpoint_up
8503 set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
8504 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
8505 {
8506 struct breakpoint *b;
8507
8508 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
8509 tail-called one. */
8510 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
8511
8512 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
8513 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8514 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8515 b->frame_id = frame_id;
8516
8517 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
8518
8519 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8520
8521 return breakpoint_up (b);
8522 }
8523
8524 /* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
8525 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
8526 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
8527
8528 static struct breakpoint *
8529 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
8530 enum bptype type,
8531 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
8532 int loc_enabled)
8533 {
8534 struct breakpoint *copy;
8535
8536 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
8537 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
8538 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc);
8539
8540 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
8541 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
8542 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
8543 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
8544 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
8545 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
8546 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
8547 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
8548 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
8549 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
8550 copy->thread = orig->thread;
8551 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
8552
8553 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
8554 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
8555 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
8556
8557 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
8558 return copy;
8559 }
8560
8561 /* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
8562 ORIG is NULL. */
8563
8564 struct breakpoint *
8565 clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
8566 {
8567 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
8568 if (orig == NULL)
8569 return NULL;
8570
8571 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
8572 }
8573
8574 breakpoint_up
8575 set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
8576 enum bptype type)
8577 {
8578 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8579
8580 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
8581 sal.pc = pc;
8582 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
8583 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
8584
8585 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
8586 }
8587 \f
8588
8589 /* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
8590
8591 static void
8592 mention (struct breakpoint *b)
8593 {
8594 b->ops->print_mention (b);
8595 current_uiout->text ("\n");
8596 }
8597 \f
8598
8599 static bool bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
8600
8601 /* Handle "set breakpoint auto-hw on".
8602
8603 If the explicitly specified breakpoint type is not hardware
8604 breakpoint, check the memory map to see whether the breakpoint
8605 address is in read-only memory.
8606
8607 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory is read-only.
8608 We change the type of the location to hardware breakpoint.
8609
8610 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is read-write. This
8611 means we've previously made the location hardware one, but then the
8612 memory map changed, so we undo.
8613 */
8614
8615 static void
8616 handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (bp_location *bl)
8617 {
8618 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints
8619 && bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint
8620 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
8621 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint))
8622 {
8623 /* When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
8624 location types we've just set here, the only possible problem
8625 is that memory map has changed during running program, but
8626 it's not going to work anyway with current gdb. */
8627 mem_region *mr = lookup_mem_region (bl->address);
8628
8629 if (mr != nullptr)
8630 {
8631 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
8632
8633 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
8634 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
8635 else
8636 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
8637
8638 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
8639 {
8640 static bool said = false;
8641
8642 bl->loc_type = new_type;
8643 if (!said)
8644 {
8645 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
8646 _("Note: automatically using "
8647 "hardware breakpoints for "
8648 "read-only addresses.\n"));
8649 said = true;
8650 }
8651 }
8652 }
8653 }
8654 }
8655
8656 static struct bp_location *
8657 add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8658 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
8659 {
8660 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
8661 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
8662 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
8663
8664 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
8665 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
8666
8667 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
8668 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
8669 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
8670 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
8671 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
8672 location that's only been partially initialized. */
8673 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
8674 sal->pc, b->type);
8675
8676 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
8677 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
8678 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
8679 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
8680 ;
8681 loc->next = *tmp;
8682 *tmp = loc;
8683
8684 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
8685 loc->address = adjusted_address;
8686 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
8687 loc->probe.prob = sal->prob;
8688 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
8689 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
8690 loc->section = sal->section;
8691 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
8692 loc->line_number = sal->line;
8693 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
8694 loc->symbol = sal->symbol;
8695 loc->msymbol = sal->msymbol;
8696 loc->objfile = sal->objfile;
8697
8698 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc);
8699
8700 /* While by definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
8701 code, we don't mark the location as inserted. Normally one would expect
8702 that GDB could rely on that breakpoint instruction to stop the program,
8703 thus removing the need to insert its own breakpoint, except that executing
8704 the breakpoint instruction can kill the target instead of reporting a
8705 SIGTRAP. E.g., on SPARC, when interrupts are disabled, executing the
8706 instruction resets the CPU, so QEMU 2.0.0 for SPARC correspondingly dies
8707 with "Trap 0x02 while interrupts disabled, Error state". Letting the
8708 breakpoint be inserted normally results in QEMU knowing about the GDB
8709 breakpoint, and thus trap before the breakpoint instruction is executed.
8710 (If GDB later needs to continue execution past the permanent breakpoint,
8711 it manually increments the PC, thus avoiding executing the breakpoint
8712 instruction.) */
8713 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
8714 loc->permanent = 1;
8715
8716 return loc;
8717 }
8718 \f
8719
8720 /* Return true if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
8721 return false otherwise. */
8722
8723 static bool
8724 bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
8725 {
8726 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
8727
8728 /* If we have a non-breakpoint-backed catchpoint or a software
8729 watchpoint, just return 0. We should not attempt to read from
8730 the addresses the locations of these breakpoint types point to.
8731 gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p, below, will attempt to read
8732 memory. */
8733 if (!bl_address_is_meaningful (loc))
8734 return false;
8735
8736 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
8737 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
8738 return gdbarch_program_breakpoint_here_p (loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
8739 }
8740
8741 /* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
8742 settings of the dprintf style options. */
8743
8744 static void
8745 update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
8746 {
8747 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
8748 char *printf_line = NULL;
8749
8750 if (!dprintf_args)
8751 return;
8752
8753 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8754
8755 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
8756 insist on it. */
8757 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
8758 ++dprintf_args;
8759 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
8760
8761 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
8762 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
8763
8764 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
8765 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8766 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
8767 {
8768 if (!dprintf_function)
8769 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
8770
8771 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
8772 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
8773 dprintf_function,
8774 dprintf_channel,
8775 dprintf_args);
8776 else
8777 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
8778 dprintf_function,
8779 dprintf_args);
8780 }
8781 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
8782 {
8783 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
8784 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
8785 else
8786 {
8787 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
8788 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
8789 }
8790 }
8791 else
8792 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
8793 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
8794
8795 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
8796
8797 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
8798 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line
8799 = new struct command_line (simple_control, printf_line);
8800 breakpoint_set_commands (b, counted_command_line (printf_cmd_line,
8801 command_lines_deleter ()));
8802 }
8803
8804 /* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
8805 current style settings. */
8806
8807 static void
8808 update_dprintf_commands (const char *args, int from_tty,
8809 struct cmd_list_element *c)
8810 {
8811 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
8812 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
8813 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8814 }
8815
8816 /* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use LOCATION
8817 as a description of the location, and COND_STRING
8818 as condition expression. If LOCATION is NULL then create an
8819 "address location" from the address in the SAL. */
8820
8821 static void
8822 init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8823 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8824 event_location_up &&location,
8825 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8826 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8827 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8828 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8829 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8830 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8831 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8832 int display_canonical)
8833 {
8834 int i;
8835
8836 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
8837 {
8838 int target_resources_ok;
8839
8840 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
8841 target_resources_ok =
8842 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
8843 i + 1, 0);
8844 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
8845 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
8846 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
8847 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
8848 }
8849
8850 gdb_assert (!sals.empty ());
8851
8852 for (const auto &sal : sals)
8853 {
8854 struct bp_location *loc;
8855
8856 if (from_tty)
8857 {
8858 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
8859 if (!loc_gdbarch)
8860 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
8861
8862 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
8863 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
8864 }
8865
8866 if (&sal == &sals[0])
8867 {
8868 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
8869 b->thread = thread;
8870 b->task = task;
8871
8872 b->cond_string = cond_string.release ();
8873 b->extra_string = extra_string.release ();
8874 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
8875 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8876 b->disposition = disposition;
8877
8878 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8879 b->loc->inserted = 1;
8880
8881 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
8882 {
8883 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
8884 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
8885
8886 if (strace_marker_p (b))
8887 {
8888 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
8889 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
8890 const char *p
8891 = &event_location_to_string (b->location.get ())[3];
8892 const char *endp;
8893
8894 p = skip_spaces (p);
8895
8896 endp = skip_to_space (p);
8897
8898 t->static_trace_marker_id.assign (p, endp - p);
8899
8900 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8901 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8902 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8903 }
8904 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
8905 {
8906 t->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
8907
8908 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
8909 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
8910 t->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
8911 }
8912 else
8913 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
8914 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
8915 }
8916
8917 loc = b->loc;
8918 }
8919 else
8920 {
8921 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
8922 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
8923 loc->inserted = 1;
8924 }
8925
8926 /* Do not set breakpoint locations conditions yet. As locations
8927 are inserted, they get sorted based on their addresses. Let
8928 the list stabilize to have reliable location numbers. */
8929
8930 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
8931 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
8932 if (type == bp_dprintf)
8933 {
8934 if (b->extra_string)
8935 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
8936 else
8937 error (_("Format string required"));
8938 }
8939 else if (b->extra_string)
8940 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
8941 }
8942
8943
8944 /* The order of the locations is now stable. Set the location
8945 condition using the location's number. */
8946 int loc_num = 1;
8947 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
8948 {
8949 if (b->cond_string != nullptr)
8950 set_breakpoint_location_condition (b->cond_string, loc, b->number,
8951 loc_num);
8952
8953 ++loc_num;
8954 }
8955
8956 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
8957 if (location != NULL)
8958 b->location = std::move (location);
8959 else
8960 b->location = new_address_location (b->loc->address, NULL, 0);
8961 b->filter = std::move (filter);
8962 }
8963
8964 static void
8965 create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8966 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
8967 event_location_up &&location,
8968 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter,
8969 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
8970 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
8971 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
8972 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
8973 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
8974 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
8975 int display_canonical)
8976 {
8977 std::unique_ptr<breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type);
8978
8979 init_breakpoint_sal (b.get (), gdbarch,
8980 sals, std::move (location),
8981 std::move (filter),
8982 std::move (cond_string),
8983 std::move (extra_string),
8984 type, disposition,
8985 thread, task, ignore_count,
8986 ops, from_tty,
8987 enabled, internal, flags,
8988 display_canonical);
8989
8990 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
8991 }
8992
8993 /* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
8994 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
8995 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
8996 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
8997 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
8998 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
8999 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
9000 we take just a single condition string.
9001
9002 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
9003 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
9004 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
9005 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
9006 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
9007
9008 static void
9009 create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9010 struct linespec_result *canonical,
9011 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
9012 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
9013 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9014 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9015 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9016 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
9017 {
9018 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
9019 gdb_assert (canonical->lsals.size () == 1);
9020
9021 for (const auto &lsal : canonical->lsals)
9022 {
9023 /* Note that 'location' can be NULL in the case of a plain
9024 'break', without arguments. */
9025 event_location_up location
9026 = (canonical->location != NULL
9027 ? copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ()) : NULL);
9028 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> filter_string
9029 (lsal.canonical != NULL ? xstrdup (lsal.canonical) : NULL);
9030
9031 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal.sals,
9032 std::move (location),
9033 std::move (filter_string),
9034 std::move (cond_string),
9035 std::move (extra_string),
9036 type, disposition,
9037 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9038 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
9039 canonical->special_display);
9040 }
9041 }
9042
9043 /* Parse LOCATION which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
9044 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
9045 addresses found. LOCATION points to the end of the SAL (for
9046 linespec locations).
9047
9048 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
9049 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
9050
9051 static void
9052 parse_breakpoint_sals (struct event_location *location,
9053 struct linespec_result *canonical)
9054 {
9055 struct symtab_and_line cursal;
9056
9057 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9058 {
9059 const char *spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9060
9061 if (spec == NULL)
9062 {
9063 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default
9064 breakpoint address. */
9065 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9066 {
9067 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9068 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9069 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9070 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9071 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9072 symtab_and_line sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
9073 CORE_ADDR pc = sal.pc;
9074
9075 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9076
9077 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9078 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9079 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9080 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9081 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9082 sal.pc = pc;
9083 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9084
9085 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9086 lsal.sals = {sal};
9087 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9088
9089 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
9090 return;
9091 }
9092 else
9093 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9094 }
9095 }
9096
9097 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9098 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9099 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9100 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9101
9102 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9103 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9104 cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9105 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9106 {
9107 const char *spec = NULL;
9108
9109 if (event_location_type (location) == LINESPEC_LOCATION)
9110 spec = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
9111
9112 if (!cursal.symtab
9113 || (spec != NULL
9114 && strchr ("+-", spec[0]) != NULL
9115 && spec[1] != '['))
9116 {
9117 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9118 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9119 get_last_displayed_line (),
9120 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9121 return;
9122 }
9123 }
9124
9125 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
9126 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9127 }
9128
9129
9130 /* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9131 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9132
9133 static void
9134 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals)
9135 {
9136 for (auto &sal : sals)
9137 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
9138 }
9139
9140 /* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9141 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9142 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9143 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9144 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9145 it, etc. */
9146
9147 static void
9148 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9149 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals)
9150 {
9151 for (const auto &sal : sals)
9152 {
9153 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9154
9155 sarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9156 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9157 associated with SAL. */
9158 if (sarch == NULL)
9159 sarch = gdbarch;
9160 std::string msg;
9161 if (!gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal.pc, &msg))
9162 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at %s%s"),
9163 paddress (sarch, sal.pc), msg.c_str ());
9164 }
9165 }
9166
9167 /* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9168 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9169 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9170 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9171 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9172 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9173
9174 static void
9175 find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9176 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9177 char **rest)
9178 {
9179 *cond_string = NULL;
9180 *thread = -1;
9181 *task = 0;
9182 *rest = NULL;
9183 bool force = false;
9184
9185 while (tok && *tok)
9186 {
9187 const char *end_tok;
9188 int toklen;
9189 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9190 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9191
9192 tok = skip_spaces (tok);
9193
9194 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9195 {
9196 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9197 return;
9198 }
9199
9200 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
9201
9202 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9203
9204 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9205 {
9206 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9207 try
9208 {
9209 parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9210 }
9211 catch (const gdb_exception_error &)
9212 {
9213 if (!force)
9214 throw;
9215 else
9216 tok = tok + strlen (tok);
9217 }
9218 cond_end = tok;
9219 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9220 }
9221 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "-force-condition", toklen) == 0)
9222 {
9223 tok = tok + toklen;
9224 force = true;
9225 }
9226 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9227 {
9228 const char *tmptok;
9229 struct thread_info *thr;
9230
9231 tok = end_tok + 1;
9232 thr = parse_thread_id (tok, &tmptok);
9233 if (tok == tmptok)
9234 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9235 *thread = thr->global_num;
9236 tok = tmptok;
9237 }
9238 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9239 {
9240 char *tmptok;
9241
9242 tok = end_tok + 1;
9243 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9244 if (tok == tmptok)
9245 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9246 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9247 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9248 tok = tmptok;
9249 }
9250 else if (rest)
9251 {
9252 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9253 return;
9254 }
9255 else
9256 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9257 }
9258 }
9259
9260 /* Call 'find_condition_and_thread' for each sal in SALS until a parse
9261 succeeds. The parsed values are written to COND_STRING, THREAD,
9262 TASK, and REST. See the comment of 'find_condition_and_thread'
9263 for the description of these parameters and INPUT. */
9264
9265 static void
9266 find_condition_and_thread_for_sals (const std::vector<symtab_and_line> &sals,
9267 const char *input, char **cond_string,
9268 int *thread, int *task, char **rest)
9269 {
9270 int num_failures = 0;
9271 for (auto &sal : sals)
9272 {
9273 char *cond = nullptr;
9274 int thread_id = 0;
9275 int task_id = 0;
9276 char *remaining = nullptr;
9277
9278 /* Here we want to parse 'arg' to separate condition from thread
9279 number. But because parsing happens in a context and the
9280 contexts of sals might be different, try each until there is
9281 success. Finding one successful parse is sufficient for our
9282 goal. When setting the breakpoint we'll re-parse the
9283 condition in the context of each sal. */
9284 try
9285 {
9286 find_condition_and_thread (input, sal.pc, &cond, &thread_id,
9287 &task_id, &remaining);
9288 *cond_string = cond;
9289 *thread = thread_id;
9290 *task = task_id;
9291 *rest = remaining;
9292 break;
9293 }
9294 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
9295 {
9296 num_failures++;
9297 /* If no sal remains, do not continue. */
9298 if (num_failures == sals.size ())
9299 throw;
9300 }
9301 }
9302 }
9303
9304 /* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9305
9306 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
9307 decode_static_tracepoint_spec (const char **arg_p)
9308 {
9309 const char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9310 const char *endp;
9311
9312 p = skip_spaces (p);
9313
9314 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9315
9316 std::string marker_str (p, endp - p);
9317
9318 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
9319 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str.c_str ());
9320 if (markers.empty ())
9321 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"),
9322 marker_str.c_str ());
9323
9324 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
9325 sals.reserve (markers.size ());
9326
9327 for (const static_tracepoint_marker &marker : markers)
9328 {
9329 symtab_and_line sal = find_pc_line (marker.address, 0);
9330 sal.pc = marker.address;
9331 sals.push_back (sal);
9332 }
9333
9334 *arg_p = endp;
9335 return sals;
9336 }
9337
9338 /* Returns the breakpoint ops appropriate for use with with LOCATION_TYPE and
9339 according to IS_TRACEPOINT. */
9340
9341 static const struct breakpoint_ops *
9342 breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type (enum event_location_type location_type,
9343 bool is_tracepoint)
9344 {
9345 if (is_tracepoint)
9346 {
9347 if (location_type == PROBE_LOCATION)
9348 return &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9349 else
9350 return &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
9351 }
9352 else
9353 {
9354 if (location_type == PROBE_LOCATION)
9355 return &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
9356 else
9357 return &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9358 }
9359 }
9360
9361 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9362
9363 const struct breakpoint_ops *
9364 breakpoint_ops_for_event_location (const struct event_location *location,
9365 bool is_tracepoint)
9366 {
9367 if (location != nullptr)
9368 return breakpoint_ops_for_event_location_type
9369 (event_location_type (location), is_tracepoint);
9370 return is_tracepoint ? &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops : &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
9371 }
9372
9373 /* See breakpoint.h. */
9374
9375 int
9376 create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9377 struct event_location *location,
9378 const char *cond_string,
9379 int thread, const char *extra_string,
9380 bool force_condition, int parse_extra,
9381 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9382 int ignore_count,
9383 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9384 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9385 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9386 unsigned flags)
9387 {
9388 struct linespec_result canonical;
9389 int pending = 0;
9390 int task = 0;
9391 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9392
9393 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9394
9395 /* If extra_string isn't useful, set it to NULL. */
9396 if (extra_string != NULL && *extra_string == '\0')
9397 extra_string = NULL;
9398
9399 try
9400 {
9401 ops->create_sals_from_location (location, &canonical, type_wanted);
9402 }
9403 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
9404 {
9405 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set
9406 value. */
9407 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
9408 {
9409 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9410 error. */
9411
9412 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9413 throw;
9414
9415 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9416
9417 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9418 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9419 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9420 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9421 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9422 return 0;
9423
9424 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9425 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9426 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9427 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9428 pending = 1;
9429 }
9430 else
9431 throw;
9432 }
9433
9434 if (!pending && canonical.lsals.empty ())
9435 return 0;
9436
9437 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
9438 are ok for the target. */
9439 if (!pending)
9440 {
9441 for (auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9442 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (lsal.sals);
9443 }
9444
9445 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
9446 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
9447 {
9448 for (const auto &lsal : canonical.lsals)
9449 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, lsal.sals);
9450 }
9451
9452 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
9453 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
9454 breakpoint. */
9455 if (!pending)
9456 {
9457 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string_copy;
9458 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string_copy;
9459
9460 if (parse_extra)
9461 {
9462 char *rest;
9463 char *cond;
9464
9465 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9466
9467 find_condition_and_thread_for_sals (lsal.sals, extra_string,
9468 &cond, &thread, &task, &rest);
9469 cond_string_copy.reset (cond);
9470 extra_string_copy.reset (rest);
9471 }
9472 else
9473 {
9474 if (type_wanted != bp_dprintf
9475 && extra_string != NULL && *extra_string != '\0')
9476 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), extra_string);
9477
9478 /* Check the validity of the condition. We should error out
9479 if the condition is invalid at all of the locations and
9480 if it is not forced. In the PARSE_EXTRA case above, this
9481 check is done when parsing the EXTRA_STRING. */
9482 if (cond_string != nullptr && !force_condition)
9483 {
9484 int num_failures = 0;
9485 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
9486 for (const auto &sal : lsal.sals)
9487 {
9488 const char *cond = cond_string;
9489 try
9490 {
9491 parse_exp_1 (&cond, sal.pc, block_for_pc (sal.pc), 0);
9492 /* One success is sufficient to keep going. */
9493 break;
9494 }
9495 catch (const gdb_exception_error &)
9496 {
9497 num_failures++;
9498 /* If this is the last sal, error out. */
9499 if (num_failures == lsal.sals.size ())
9500 throw;
9501 }
9502 }
9503 }
9504
9505 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9506 if (cond_string)
9507 cond_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (cond_string));
9508 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9509 if (extra_string)
9510 extra_string_copy.reset (xstrdup (extra_string));
9511 }
9512
9513 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
9514 std::move (cond_string_copy),
9515 std::move (extra_string_copy),
9516 type_wanted,
9517 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
9518 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9519 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
9520 }
9521 else
9522 {
9523 std::unique_ptr <breakpoint> b = new_breakpoint_from_type (type_wanted);
9524
9525 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b.get (), gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
9526 b->location = copy_event_location (location);
9527
9528 if (parse_extra)
9529 b->cond_string = NULL;
9530 else
9531 {
9532 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
9533 b->cond_string = cond_string != NULL ? xstrdup (cond_string) : NULL;
9534 b->thread = thread;
9535 }
9536
9537 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
9538 b->extra_string = extra_string != NULL ? xstrdup (extra_string) : NULL;
9539 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9540 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
9541 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
9542 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9543 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
9544 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
9545 b->pspace = current_program_space;
9546
9547 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (b), 0);
9548 }
9549
9550 if (canonical.lsals.size () > 1)
9551 {
9552 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
9553 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
9554 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
9555 }
9556
9557 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9558
9559 return 1;
9560 }
9561
9562 /* Set a breakpoint.
9563 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
9564 condition, and thread.
9565 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
9566 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
9567 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
9568
9569 static void
9570 break_command_1 (const char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
9571 {
9572 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
9573 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
9574 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
9575 : bp_breakpoint);
9576
9577 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9578 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_event_location
9579 (location.get (), false /* is_tracepoint */);
9580
9581 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9582 location.get (),
9583 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
9584 tempflag, type_wanted,
9585 0 /* Ignore count */,
9586 pending_break_support,
9587 ops,
9588 from_tty,
9589 1 /* enabled */,
9590 0 /* internal */,
9591 0);
9592 }
9593
9594 /* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
9595
9596 void
9597 resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9598 {
9599 CORE_ADDR pc;
9600
9601 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9602 {
9603 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
9604 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
9605 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
9606 sal->pc = pc;
9607
9608 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
9609 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
9610 if (sal->explicit_line)
9611 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
9612 }
9613
9614 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
9615 {
9616 const struct blockvector *bv;
9617 const struct block *b;
9618 struct symbol *sym;
9619
9620 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b,
9621 SYMTAB_COMPUNIT (sal->symtab));
9622 if (bv != NULL)
9623 {
9624 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
9625 if (sym != NULL)
9626 {
9627 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9628 sal->section = sym->obj_section (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
9629 }
9630 else
9631 {
9632 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
9633 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
9634 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
9635 happen in assembly source). */
9636
9637 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
9638 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
9639
9640 bound_minimal_symbol msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
9641 if (msym.minsym)
9642 sal->section = msym.obj_section ();
9643 }
9644 }
9645 }
9646 }
9647
9648 void
9649 break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9650 {
9651 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9652 }
9653
9654 void
9655 tbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9656 {
9657 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
9658 }
9659
9660 static void
9661 hbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9662 {
9663 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
9664 }
9665
9666 static void
9667 thbreak_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9668 {
9669 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
9670 }
9671
9672 static void
9673 stop_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9674 {
9675 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
9676 Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
9677 stop at <line>\n"));
9678 }
9679
9680 static void
9681 stopin_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9682 {
9683 int badInput = 0;
9684
9685 if (arg == NULL)
9686 badInput = 1;
9687 else if (*arg != '*')
9688 {
9689 const char *argptr = arg;
9690 int hasColon = 0;
9691
9692 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
9693 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
9694 function/method name. */
9695 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9696 {
9697 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9698 argptr++;
9699 }
9700
9701 if (hasColon)
9702 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
9703 else
9704 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
9705 }
9706
9707 if (badInput)
9708 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
9709 else
9710 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9711 }
9712
9713 static void
9714 stopat_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9715 {
9716 int badInput = 0;
9717
9718 if (arg == NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
9719 badInput = 1;
9720 else
9721 {
9722 const char *argptr = arg;
9723 int hasColon = 0;
9724
9725 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
9726 it is probably a line number. */
9727 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
9728 {
9729 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
9730 argptr++;
9731 }
9732
9733 if (hasColon)
9734 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
9735 else
9736 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
9737 }
9738
9739 if (badInput)
9740 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at LINE\n"));
9741 else
9742 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
9743 }
9744
9745 /* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
9746 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
9747 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
9748 line. */
9749
9750 static void
9751 dprintf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9752 {
9753 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
9754
9755 /* If non-NULL, ARG should have been advanced past the location;
9756 the next character must be ','. */
9757 if (arg != NULL)
9758 {
9759 if (arg[0] != ',' || arg[1] == '\0')
9760 error (_("Format string required"));
9761 else
9762 {
9763 /* Skip the comma. */
9764 ++arg;
9765 }
9766 }
9767
9768 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
9769 location.get (),
9770 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
9771 0, bp_dprintf,
9772 0 /* Ignore count */,
9773 pending_break_support,
9774 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
9775 from_tty,
9776 1 /* enabled */,
9777 0 /* internal */,
9778 0);
9779 }
9780
9781 static void
9782 agent_printf_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9783 {
9784 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
9785 }
9786
9787 /* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
9788 ranged breakpoints. */
9789
9790 static int
9791 breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
9792 const address_space *aspace,
9793 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
9794 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
9795 {
9796 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
9797 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
9798 return 0;
9799
9800 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
9801 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
9802 }
9803
9804 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
9805 ranged breakpoints. */
9806
9807 static int
9808 resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
9809 {
9810 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9811 }
9812
9813 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
9814 ranged breakpoints. */
9815
9816 static enum print_stop_action
9817 print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
9818 {
9819 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
9820 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9821 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9822
9823 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9824
9825 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9826 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9827
9828 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
9829
9830 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
9831
9832 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
9833 uiout->text ("Temporary ranged breakpoint ");
9834 else
9835 uiout->text ("Ranged breakpoint ");
9836 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
9837 {
9838 uiout->field_string ("reason",
9839 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
9840 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
9841 }
9842 uiout->field_signed ("bkptno", b->number);
9843 uiout->text (", ");
9844
9845 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
9846 }
9847
9848 /* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
9849 ranged breakpoints. */
9850
9851 static void
9852 print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9853 struct bp_location **last_loc)
9854 {
9855 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9856 struct value_print_options opts;
9857 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9858
9859 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
9860 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
9861
9862 get_user_print_options (&opts);
9863
9864 if (opts.addressprint)
9865 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
9866 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
9867 uiout->field_skip ("addr");
9868 annotate_field (5);
9869 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
9870 *last_loc = bl;
9871 }
9872
9873 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
9874 ranged breakpoints. */
9875
9876 static void
9877 print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
9878 struct ui_out *uiout)
9879 {
9880 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
9881 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9882 string_file stb;
9883
9884 gdb_assert (bl);
9885
9886 address_start = bl->address;
9887 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
9888
9889 uiout->text ("\taddress range: ");
9890 stb.printf ("[%s, %s]",
9891 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
9892 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
9893 uiout->field_stream ("addr", stb);
9894 uiout->text ("\n");
9895 }
9896
9897 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
9898 ranged breakpoints. */
9899
9900 static void
9901 print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
9902 {
9903 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
9904 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
9905
9906 gdb_assert (bl);
9907 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
9908
9909 uiout->message (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
9910 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
9911 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
9912 }
9913
9914 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
9915 ranged breakpoints. */
9916
9917 static void
9918 print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
9919 {
9920 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s",
9921 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
9922 event_location_to_string (b->location_range_end.get ()));
9923 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
9924 }
9925
9926 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
9927
9928 static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
9929
9930 /* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
9931 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
9932 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
9933 last instruction of the given line. */
9934
9935 static CORE_ADDR
9936 find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
9937 {
9938 CORE_ADDR end;
9939
9940 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
9941 find the address of the end of the given location. */
9942 if (sal.explicit_pc)
9943 end = sal.pc;
9944 else
9945 {
9946 int ret;
9947 CORE_ADDR start;
9948
9949 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
9950 if (!ret)
9951 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
9952
9953 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
9954 end--;
9955 }
9956
9957 return end;
9958 }
9959
9960 /* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
9961
9962 static void
9963 break_range_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
9964 {
9965 const char *arg_start;
9966 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
9967 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
9968 CORE_ADDR end;
9969 struct breakpoint *b;
9970
9971 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
9972 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
9973 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
9974
9975 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9976 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
9977 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9978 bp_count, 0);
9979 if (can_use_bp < 0)
9980 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9981
9982 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
9983 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
9984 error(_("No address range specified."));
9985
9986 arg_start = arg;
9987 event_location_up start_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
9988 current_language);
9989 parse_breakpoint_sals (start_location.get (), &canonical_start);
9990
9991 if (arg[0] != ',')
9992 error (_("Too few arguments."));
9993 else if (canonical_start.lsals.empty ())
9994 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
9995
9996 const linespec_sals &lsal_start = canonical_start.lsals[0];
9997
9998 if (canonical_start.lsals.size () > 1
9999 || lsal_start.sals.size () != 1)
10000 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10001
10002 const symtab_and_line &sal_start = lsal_start.sals[0];
10003 std::string addr_string_start (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
10004
10005 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
10006 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10007
10008 /* Parse the end location. */
10009
10010 arg_start = arg;
10011
10012 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
10013 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
10014 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
10015 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
10016 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
10017 event_location_up end_location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
10018 current_language);
10019 decode_line_full (end_location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
10020 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
10021 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
10022
10023 if (canonical_end.lsals.empty ())
10024 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10025
10026 const linespec_sals &lsal_end = canonical_end.lsals[0];
10027 if (canonical_end.lsals.size () > 1
10028 || lsal_end.sals.size () != 1)
10029 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10030
10031 const symtab_and_line &sal_end = lsal_end.sals[0];
10032
10033 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
10034 if (sal_start.pc > end)
10035 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
10036
10037 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
10038 if (length < 0)
10039 /* Length overflowed. */
10040 error (_("Address range too large."));
10041 else if (length == 1)
10042 {
10043 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
10044 the `hbreak' command. */
10045 hbreak_command (&addr_string_start[0], 1);
10046
10047 return;
10048 }
10049
10050 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
10051 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
10052 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
10053 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
10054 b->number = breakpoint_count;
10055 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10056 b->location = std::move (start_location);
10057 b->location_range_end = std::move (end_location);
10058 b->loc->length = length;
10059
10060 mention (b);
10061 gdb::observers::breakpoint_created.notify (b);
10062 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
10063 }
10064
10065 /* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
10066 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
10067 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
10068 zero. */
10069
10070 static bool
10071 watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
10072 {
10073 return exp->op->constant_p ();
10074 }
10075
10076 /* Watchpoint destructor. */
10077
10078 watchpoint::~watchpoint ()
10079 {
10080 xfree (this->exp_string);
10081 xfree (this->exp_string_reparse);
10082 }
10083
10084 /* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10085
10086 static void
10087 re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10088 {
10089 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10090
10091 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10092 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10093
10094 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10095 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10096 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10097 are loaded and unloaded.
10098
10099 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10100 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10101 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10102 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10103 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10104 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10105
10106 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10107 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10108 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10109 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10110
10111 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10112 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10113
10114 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10115 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10116 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10117 }
10118
10119 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10120
10121 static int
10122 insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10123 {
10124 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10125 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10126
10127 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10128 w->cond_exp.get ());
10129 }
10130
10131 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10132
10133 static int
10134 remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10135 {
10136 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10137 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10138
10139 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10140 w->cond_exp.get ());
10141 }
10142
10143 static int
10144 breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10145 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10146 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10147 {
10148 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10149 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10150
10151 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10152 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10153 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10154 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10155 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10156 (did not match the data address). */
10157 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10158 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10159 return 0;
10160
10161 return 1;
10162 }
10163
10164 static void
10165 check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10166 {
10167 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10168
10169 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10170 }
10171
10172 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10173 hardware watchpoints. */
10174
10175 static int
10176 resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10177 {
10178 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10179 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10180
10181 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10182 }
10183
10184 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10185 hardware watchpoints. */
10186
10187 static int
10188 works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10189 {
10190 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10191 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10192 }
10193
10194 static enum print_stop_action
10195 print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10196 {
10197 struct breakpoint *b;
10198 enum print_stop_action result;
10199 struct watchpoint *w;
10200 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10201
10202 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10203
10204 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10205 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10206
10207 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10208 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10209
10210 string_file stb;
10211
10212 gdb::optional<ui_out_emit_tuple> tuple_emitter;
10213 switch (b->type)
10214 {
10215 case bp_watchpoint:
10216 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10217 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10218 uiout->field_string
10219 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10220 mention (b);
10221 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10222 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10223 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10224 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10225 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10226 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10227 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10228 uiout->text ("\n");
10229 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10230 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10231 break;
10232
10233 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10234 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10235 uiout->field_string
10236 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10237 mention (b);
10238 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10239 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10240 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10241 uiout->field_stream ("value", stb);
10242 uiout->text ("\n");
10243 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10244 break;
10245
10246 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10247 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10248 {
10249 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10250 uiout->field_string
10251 ("reason",
10252 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10253 mention (b);
10254 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10255 uiout->text ("\nOld value = ");
10256 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val.get (), &stb);
10257 uiout->field_stream ("old", stb);
10258 uiout->text ("\nNew value = ");
10259 }
10260 else
10261 {
10262 mention (b);
10263 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10264 uiout->field_string
10265 ("reason",
10266 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10267 tuple_emitter.emplace (uiout, "value");
10268 uiout->text ("\nValue = ");
10269 }
10270 watchpoint_value_print (w->val.get (), &stb);
10271 uiout->field_stream ("new", stb);
10272 uiout->text ("\n");
10273 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10274 break;
10275 default:
10276 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10277 }
10278
10279 return result;
10280 }
10281
10282 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10283 watchpoints. */
10284
10285 static void
10286 print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10287 {
10288 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10289 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10290 const char *tuple_name;
10291
10292 switch (b->type)
10293 {
10294 case bp_watchpoint:
10295 uiout->text ("Watchpoint ");
10296 tuple_name = "wpt";
10297 break;
10298 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10299 uiout->text ("Hardware watchpoint ");
10300 tuple_name = "wpt";
10301 break;
10302 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10303 uiout->text ("Hardware read watchpoint ");
10304 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10305 break;
10306 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10307 uiout->text ("Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10308 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10309 break;
10310 default:
10311 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10312 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10313 }
10314
10315 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10316 uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
10317 uiout->text (": ");
10318 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10319 }
10320
10321 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10322 watchpoints. */
10323
10324 static void
10325 print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10326 {
10327 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10328
10329 switch (b->type)
10330 {
10331 case bp_watchpoint:
10332 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10333 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10334 break;
10335 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10336 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10337 break;
10338 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10339 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10340 break;
10341 default:
10342 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10343 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
10344 }
10345
10346 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
10347 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10348 }
10349
10350 /* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
10351 watchpoints. */
10352
10353 static int
10354 explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
10355 {
10356 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
10357 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
10358 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10359 return 0;
10360
10361 return 1;
10362 }
10363
10364 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
10365
10366 static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10367
10368 /* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
10369 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10370
10371 static int
10372 insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10373 {
10374 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10375
10376 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10377 bl->watchpoint_type);
10378 }
10379
10380 /* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
10381 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10382
10383 static int
10384 remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
10385 {
10386 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10387
10388 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
10389 bl->watchpoint_type);
10390 }
10391
10392 /* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10393 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10394
10395 static int
10396 resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10397 {
10398 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10399
10400 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
10401 }
10402
10403 /* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10404 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10405
10406 static int
10407 works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10408 {
10409 return 0;
10410 }
10411
10412 /* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10413 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10414
10415 static enum print_stop_action
10416 print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10417 {
10418 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10419 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10420
10421 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10422 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10423
10424 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10425 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
10426
10427 switch (b->type)
10428 {
10429 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10430 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10431 uiout->field_string
10432 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10433 break;
10434
10435 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10436 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10437 uiout->field_string
10438 ("reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10439 break;
10440
10441 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10442 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
10443 uiout->field_string
10444 ("reason",
10445 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10446 break;
10447 default:
10448 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10449 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10450 }
10451
10452 mention (b);
10453 uiout->text (_("\n\
10454 Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
10455 address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
10456 uiout->text ("\n");
10457
10458 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10459 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10460 }
10461
10462 /* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10463 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10464
10465 static void
10466 print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10467 struct ui_out *uiout)
10468 {
10469 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10470
10471 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
10472 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
10473
10474 uiout->text ("\tmask ");
10475 uiout->field_core_addr ("mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
10476 uiout->text ("\n");
10477 }
10478
10479 /* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10480 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10481
10482 static void
10483 print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10484 {
10485 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10486 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10487 const char *tuple_name;
10488
10489 switch (b->type)
10490 {
10491 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10492 uiout->text ("Masked hardware watchpoint ");
10493 tuple_name = "wpt";
10494 break;
10495 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10496 uiout->text ("Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
10497 tuple_name = "hw-rwpt";
10498 break;
10499 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10500 uiout->text ("Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
10501 tuple_name = "hw-awpt";
10502 break;
10503 default:
10504 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10505 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10506 }
10507
10508 ui_out_emit_tuple tuple_emitter (uiout, tuple_name);
10509 uiout->field_signed ("number", b->number);
10510 uiout->text (": ");
10511 uiout->field_string ("exp", w->exp_string);
10512 }
10513
10514 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10515 masked hardware watchpoints. */
10516
10517 static void
10518 print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10519 {
10520 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10521
10522 switch (b->type)
10523 {
10524 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10525 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
10526 break;
10527 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10528 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
10529 break;
10530 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10531 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
10532 break;
10533 default:
10534 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
10535 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
10536 }
10537
10538 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string,
10539 phex (w->hw_wp_mask, sizeof (CORE_ADDR)));
10540 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10541 }
10542
10543 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
10544
10545 static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10546
10547 /* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
10548
10549 static bool
10550 is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10551 {
10552 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
10553 }
10554
10555 /* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
10556 hw_read: watch read,
10557 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
10558 static void
10559 watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
10560 bool just_location, bool internal)
10561 {
10562 struct breakpoint *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
10563 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
10564 struct value *result;
10565 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
10566 const char *exp_start = NULL;
10567 const char *exp_end = NULL;
10568 const char *tok, *end_tok;
10569 int toklen = -1;
10570 const char *cond_start = NULL;
10571 const char *cond_end = NULL;
10572 enum bptype bp_type;
10573 int thread = -1;
10574 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
10575 the hardware watchpoint. */
10576 bool use_mask = false;
10577 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
10578
10579 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
10580 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
10581 {
10582 const char *value_start;
10583
10584 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
10585
10586 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
10587 of the arguments string. */
10588 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
10589 {
10590 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
10591 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10592 tok--;
10593
10594 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
10595 This is the value of the parameter. */
10596 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10597 tok--;
10598 value_start = tok + 1;
10599
10600 /* Skip whitespace. */
10601 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
10602 tok--;
10603
10604 end_tok = tok;
10605
10606 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
10607 This is the parameter itself. */
10608 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
10609 tok--;
10610 tok++;
10611 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
10612
10613 if (toklen == 6 && startswith (tok, "thread"))
10614 {
10615 struct thread_info *thr;
10616 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
10617 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
10618 only in a specific thread. */
10619 const char *endp;
10620
10621 if (thread != -1)
10622 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
10623
10624 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
10625 thr = parse_thread_id (value_start, &endp);
10626
10627 /* Check if the user provided a valid thread ID. */
10628 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
10629 invalid_thread_id_error (value_start);
10630
10631 thread = thr->global_num;
10632 }
10633 else if (toklen == 4 && startswith (tok, "mask"))
10634 {
10635 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
10636 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
10637 facility. */
10638 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
10639
10640 if (use_mask)
10641 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
10642
10643 use_mask = just_location = true;
10644
10645 mark = value_mark ();
10646 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
10647 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
10648 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10649 }
10650 else
10651 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
10652 break;
10653
10654 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
10655 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
10656 exp_end = tok;
10657 }
10658 }
10659 else
10660 exp_end = arg;
10661
10662 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
10663 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
10664 ARG. */
10665 std::string expression (arg, exp_end - arg);
10666 exp_start = arg = expression.c_str ();
10667 innermost_block_tracker tracker;
10668 expression_up exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0, &tracker);
10669 exp_end = arg;
10670 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
10671 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
10672 prettier. */
10673 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
10674 --exp_end;
10675
10676 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
10677 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp.get ()))
10678 {
10679 int len;
10680
10681 len = exp_end - exp_start;
10682 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
10683 len--;
10684 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
10685 }
10686
10687 exp_valid_block = tracker.block ();
10688 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
10689 struct value *val_as_value = nullptr;
10690 fetch_subexp_value (exp.get (), exp->op.get (), &val_as_value, &result, NULL,
10691 just_location);
10692
10693 if (val_as_value != NULL && just_location)
10694 {
10695 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val_as_value);
10696 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val_as_value);
10697 }
10698
10699 value_ref_ptr val;
10700 if (just_location)
10701 {
10702 int ret;
10703
10704 exp_valid_block = NULL;
10705 val = release_value (value_addr (result));
10706 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10707
10708 if (use_mask)
10709 {
10710 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val.get ()),
10711 mask);
10712 if (ret == -1)
10713 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
10714 else if (ret == -2)
10715 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
10716 }
10717 }
10718 else if (val_as_value != NULL)
10719 val = release_value (val_as_value);
10720
10721 tok = skip_spaces (arg);
10722 end_tok = skip_to_space (tok);
10723
10724 toklen = end_tok - tok;
10725 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
10726 {
10727 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
10728 innermost_block_tracker if_tracker;
10729 parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0, &if_tracker);
10730
10731 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
10732 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
10733 cond_exp_valid_block = if_tracker.block ();
10734
10735 cond_end = tok;
10736 }
10737 if (*tok)
10738 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
10739
10740 frame_info *wp_frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
10741
10742 /* Save this because create_internal_breakpoint below invalidates
10743 'wp_frame'. */
10744 frame_id watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (wp_frame);
10745
10746 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
10747 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
10748 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
10749 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
10750 if (exp_valid_block != NULL && wp_frame != NULL)
10751 {
10752 frame_id caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (wp_frame);
10753
10754 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
10755 {
10756 gdbarch *caller_arch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (wp_frame);
10757 CORE_ADDR caller_pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (wp_frame);
10758
10759 scope_breakpoint
10760 = create_internal_breakpoint (caller_arch, caller_pc,
10761 bp_watchpoint_scope,
10762 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
10763
10764 /* create_internal_breakpoint could invalidate WP_FRAME. */
10765 wp_frame = NULL;
10766
10767 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
10768
10769 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
10770 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
10771
10772 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
10773 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = caller_frame_id;
10774
10775 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
10776 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch = caller_arch;
10777 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address = caller_pc;
10778 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
10779 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
10780 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
10781 scope_breakpoint->type);
10782 }
10783 }
10784
10785 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
10786 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
10787 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
10788 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
10789
10790 if (accessflag == hw_read)
10791 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
10792 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
10793 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
10794 else
10795 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10796
10797 std::unique_ptr<watchpoint> w (new watchpoint ());
10798
10799 if (use_mask)
10800 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10801 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10802 else
10803 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (w.get (), NULL, bp_type,
10804 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
10805 w->thread = thread;
10806 w->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10807 w->pspace = current_program_space;
10808 w->exp = std::move (exp);
10809 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
10810 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
10811 if (just_location)
10812 {
10813 struct type *t = value_type (val.get ());
10814 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val.get ());
10815
10816 w->exp_string_reparse
10817 = current_language->watch_location_expression (t, addr).release ();
10818
10819 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
10820 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
10821 }
10822 else
10823 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
10824
10825 if (use_mask)
10826 {
10827 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
10828 }
10829 else
10830 {
10831 w->val = val;
10832 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
10833 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
10834 w->val_valid = true;
10835 }
10836
10837 if (cond_start)
10838 w->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
10839 else
10840 w->cond_string = 0;
10841
10842 if (frame_id_p (watchpoint_frame))
10843 {
10844 w->watchpoint_frame = watchpoint_frame;
10845 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
10846 }
10847 else
10848 {
10849 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
10850 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
10851 }
10852
10853 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
10854 {
10855 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
10856 need to act on them together. */
10857 w->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
10858 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = w.get ();
10859 }
10860
10861 if (!just_location)
10862 value_free_to_mark (mark);
10863
10864 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
10865 that should be inserted. */
10866 update_watchpoint (w.get (), 1);
10867
10868 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (w), 1);
10869 }
10870
10871 /* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
10872 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
10873
10874 static int
10875 can_use_hardware_watchpoint (const std::vector<value_ref_ptr> &vals)
10876 {
10877 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
10878
10879 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
10880 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
10881 return 0;
10882
10883 gdb_assert (!vals.empty ());
10884 struct value *head = vals[0].get ();
10885
10886 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
10887 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
10888 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
10889 hardware watchpoint.
10890
10891 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
10892 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
10893 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
10894 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
10895 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
10896 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
10897 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
10898 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
10899 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
10900
10901 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
10902 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
10903 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
10904 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
10905 for (const value_ref_ptr &iter : vals)
10906 {
10907 struct value *v = iter.get ();
10908
10909 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
10910 {
10911 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
10912 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
10913 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
10914 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
10915 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
10916 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
10917 ;
10918 else
10919 {
10920 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
10921 it with hardware watchpoints. */
10922 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
10923
10924 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
10925 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
10926 middle of some value chain. */
10927 if (v == head
10928 || (vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
10929 && vtype->code () != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
10930 {
10931 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
10932 int len;
10933 int num_regs;
10934
10935 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
10936 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
10937 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
10938
10939 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
10940 if (!num_regs)
10941 return 0;
10942 else
10943 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
10944 }
10945 }
10946 }
10947 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
10948 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
10949 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
10950 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
10951 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
10952 }
10953
10954 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
10955 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
10956 return found_memory_cnt;
10957 }
10958
10959 void
10960 watch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal)
10961 {
10962 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
10963 }
10964
10965 /* Options for the watch, awatch, and rwatch commands. */
10966
10967 struct watch_options
10968 {
10969 /* For -location. */
10970 bool location = false;
10971 };
10972
10973 /* Definitions of options for the "watch", "awatch", and "rwatch" commands.
10974
10975 Historically GDB always accepted both '-location' and '-l' flags for
10976 these commands (both flags being synonyms). When converting to the
10977 newer option scheme only '-location' is added here. That's fine (for
10978 backward compatibility) as any non-ambiguous prefix of a flag will be
10979 accepted, so '-l', '-loc', are now all accepted.
10980
10981 What this means is that, if in the future, we add any new flag here
10982 that starts with '-l' then this will break backward compatibility, so
10983 please, don't do that! */
10984
10985 static const gdb::option::option_def watch_option_defs[] = {
10986 gdb::option::flag_option_def<watch_options> {
10987 "location",
10988 [] (watch_options *opt) { return &opt->location; },
10989 N_("\
10990 This evaluates EXPRESSION and watches the memory to which is refers.\n\
10991 -l can be used as a short form of -location."),
10992 },
10993 };
10994
10995 /* Returns the option group used by 'watch', 'awatch', and 'rwatch'
10996 commands. */
10997
10998 static gdb::option::option_def_group
10999 make_watch_options_def_group (watch_options *opts)
11000 {
11001 return {{watch_option_defs}, opts};
11002 }
11003
11004 /* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
11005 calls watch_command_1. */
11006
11007 static void
11008 watch_maybe_just_location (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
11009 {
11010 watch_options opts;
11011 auto grp = make_watch_options_def_group (&opts);
11012 gdb::option::process_options
11013 (&arg, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_OPERAND, grp);
11014 if (arg != nullptr && *arg == '\0')
11015 arg = nullptr;
11016
11017 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, opts.location, false);
11018 }
11019
11020 /* Command completion for 'watch', 'awatch', and 'rwatch' commands. */
11021 static void
11022 watch_command_completer (struct cmd_list_element *ignore,
11023 completion_tracker &tracker,
11024 const char *text, const char * /*word*/)
11025 {
11026 const auto group = make_watch_options_def_group (nullptr);
11027 if (gdb::option::complete_options
11028 (tracker, &text, gdb::option::PROCESS_OPTIONS_UNKNOWN_IS_OPERAND, group))
11029 return;
11030
11031 const char *word = advance_to_expression_complete_word_point (tracker, text);
11032 expression_completer (ignore, tracker, text, word);
11033 }
11034
11035 static void
11036 watch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11037 {
11038 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
11039 }
11040
11041 void
11042 rwatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal)
11043 {
11044 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
11045 }
11046
11047 static void
11048 rwatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11049 {
11050 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
11051 }
11052
11053 void
11054 awatch_command_wrapper (const char *arg, int from_tty, bool internal)
11055 {
11056 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
11057 }
11058
11059 static void
11060 awatch_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11061 {
11062 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
11063 }
11064 \f
11065
11066 /* Data for the FSM that manages the until(location)/advance commands
11067 in infcmd.c. Here because it uses the mechanisms of
11068 breakpoints. */
11069
11070 struct until_break_fsm : public thread_fsm
11071 {
11072 /* The thread that was current when the command was executed. */
11073 int thread;
11074
11075 /* The breakpoint set at the return address in the caller frame,
11076 plus breakpoints at all the destination locations. */
11077 std::vector<breakpoint_up> breakpoints;
11078
11079 until_break_fsm (struct interp *cmd_interp, int thread,
11080 std::vector<breakpoint_up> &&breakpoints)
11081 : thread_fsm (cmd_interp),
11082 thread (thread),
11083 breakpoints (std::move (breakpoints))
11084 {
11085 }
11086
11087 void clean_up (struct thread_info *thread) override;
11088 bool should_stop (struct thread_info *thread) override;
11089 enum async_reply_reason do_async_reply_reason () override;
11090 };
11091
11092 /* Implementation of the 'should_stop' FSM method for the
11093 until(location)/advance commands. */
11094
11095 bool
11096 until_break_fsm::should_stop (struct thread_info *tp)
11097 {
11098 for (const breakpoint_up &bp : breakpoints)
11099 if (bpstat_find_breakpoint (tp->control.stop_bpstat,
11100 bp.get ()) != NULL)
11101 {
11102 set_finished ();
11103 break;
11104 }
11105
11106 return true;
11107 }
11108
11109 /* Implementation of the 'clean_up' FSM method for the
11110 until(location)/advance commands. */
11111
11112 void
11113 until_break_fsm::clean_up (struct thread_info *)
11114 {
11115 /* Clean up our temporary breakpoints. */
11116 breakpoints.clear ();
11117 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (thread);
11118 }
11119
11120 /* Implementation of the 'async_reply_reason' FSM method for the
11121 until(location)/advance commands. */
11122
11123 enum async_reply_reason
11124 until_break_fsm::do_async_reply_reason ()
11125 {
11126 return EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED;
11127 }
11128
11129 void
11130 until_break_command (const char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11131 {
11132 struct frame_info *frame;
11133 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11134 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11135 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11136 int thread;
11137 struct thread_info *tp;
11138
11139 clear_proceed_status (0);
11140
11141 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11142 this function. */
11143
11144 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
11145
11146 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals
11147 = (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
11148 ? decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, NULL,
11149 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11150 get_last_displayed_line ())
11151 : decode_line_1 (location.get (), DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11152 NULL, NULL, 0));
11153
11154 if (sals.empty ())
11155 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11156
11157 if (*arg)
11158 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11159
11160 tp = inferior_thread ();
11161 thread = tp->global_num;
11162
11163 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11164 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11165 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11166 that. */
11167
11168 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11169 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11170 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11171 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11172
11173 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11174 one. */
11175
11176 std::vector<breakpoint_up> breakpoints;
11177
11178 gdb::optional<delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup> lj_deleter;
11179
11180 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11181 {
11182 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11183 struct gdbarch *caller_gdbarch;
11184
11185 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11186 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11187 caller_gdbarch = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11188
11189 breakpoint_up caller_breakpoint
11190 = set_momentary_breakpoint (caller_gdbarch, sal2,
11191 caller_frame_id, bp_until);
11192 breakpoints.emplace_back (std::move (caller_breakpoint));
11193
11194 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11195 lj_deleter.emplace (thread);
11196 }
11197
11198 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11199 frame = NULL;
11200
11201 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location, we
11202 don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. Otherwise,
11203 specify the selected frame, because we want to stop only at the
11204 very same frame. */
11205 frame_id stop_frame_id = anywhere ? null_frame_id : stack_frame_id;
11206
11207 for (symtab_and_line &sal : sals)
11208 {
11209 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11210
11211 breakpoint_up location_breakpoint
11212 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11213 stop_frame_id, bp_until);
11214 breakpoints.emplace_back (std::move (location_breakpoint));
11215 }
11216
11217 tp->thread_fsm = new until_break_fsm (command_interp (), tp->global_num,
11218 std::move (breakpoints));
11219
11220 if (lj_deleter)
11221 lj_deleter->release ();
11222
11223 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT);
11224 }
11225
11226 /* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11227 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11228
11229 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11230 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11231 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11232 if clause in the arg string. */
11233
11234 const char *
11235 ep_parse_optional_if_clause (const char **arg)
11236 {
11237 const char *cond_string;
11238
11239 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11240 return NULL;
11241
11242 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11243 (*arg) += 2;
11244
11245 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11246 condition string. */
11247 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11248 cond_string = *arg;
11249
11250 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11251 string. */
11252 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11253
11254 return cond_string;
11255 }
11256
11257 /* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11258 process start/exit, etc. */
11259
11260 typedef enum
11261 {
11262 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11263 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11264 }
11265 catch_fork_kind;
11266
11267 static void
11268 catch_fork_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11269 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11270 {
11271 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11272 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11273 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11274
11275 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11276 bool temp = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11277 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11278
11279 if (!arg)
11280 arg = "";
11281 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11282
11283 /* The allowed syntax is:
11284 catch [v]fork
11285 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11286
11287 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11288 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11289
11290 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11291 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11292
11293 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11294 and enable reporting of such events. */
11295 switch (fork_kind)
11296 {
11297 case catch_fork_temporary:
11298 case catch_fork_permanent:
11299 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, temp, cond_string,
11300 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11301 break;
11302 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11303 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11304 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, temp, cond_string,
11305 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11306 break;
11307 default:
11308 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11309 break;
11310 }
11311 }
11312
11313 static void
11314 catch_exec_command_1 (const char *arg, int from_tty,
11315 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11316 {
11317 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11318 const char *cond_string = NULL;
11319 bool temp = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11320
11321 if (!arg)
11322 arg = "";
11323 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11324
11325 /* The allowed syntax is:
11326 catch exec
11327 catch exec if <cond>
11328
11329 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11330 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11331
11332 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11333 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11334
11335 std::unique_ptr<exec_catchpoint> c (new exec_catchpoint ());
11336 init_catchpoint (c.get (), gdbarch, temp, cond_string,
11337 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11338 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11339
11340 install_breakpoint (0, std::move (c), 1);
11341 }
11342
11343 void
11344 init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11345 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11346 struct symtab_and_line sal,
11347 const char *addr_string,
11348 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
11349 int tempflag,
11350 int enabled,
11351 int from_tty)
11352 {
11353 if (from_tty)
11354 {
11355 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
11356 if (!loc_gdbarch)
11357 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
11358
11359 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
11360 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
11361 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
11362 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
11363 used for different exception names will use the same address.
11364 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
11365 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
11366 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
11367 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
11368 enough for now, though. */
11369 }
11370
11371 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
11372
11373 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
11374 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
11375 b->location = string_to_event_location (&addr_string,
11376 language_def (language_ada));
11377 b->language = language_ada;
11378 }
11379
11380 \f
11381
11382 /* Compare two breakpoints and return a strcmp-like result. */
11383
11384 static int
11385 compare_breakpoints (const breakpoint *a, const breakpoint *b)
11386 {
11387 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) a;
11388 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) b;
11389
11390 if (a->number < b->number)
11391 return -1;
11392 else if (a->number > b->number)
11393 return 1;
11394
11395 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
11396 the number 0. */
11397 if (ua < ub)
11398 return -1;
11399 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
11400 }
11401
11402 /* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
11403
11404 static void
11405 clear_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
11406 {
11407 int default_match;
11408
11409 std::vector<symtab_and_line> decoded_sals;
11410 symtab_and_line last_sal;
11411 gdb::array_view<symtab_and_line> sals;
11412 if (arg)
11413 {
11414 decoded_sals
11415 = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
11416 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
11417 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
11418 default_match = 0;
11419 sals = decoded_sals;
11420 }
11421 else
11422 {
11423 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
11424 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
11425 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
11426 last_sal = get_last_displayed_sal ();
11427 if (last_sal.symtab == 0)
11428 error (_("No source file specified."));
11429
11430 default_match = 1;
11431 sals = last_sal;
11432 }
11433
11434 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
11435 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
11436 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
11437 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
11438
11439 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
11440 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
11441 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
11442 due to optimization, all in one block.
11443
11444 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
11445 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
11446 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
11447 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
11448 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
11449 to support that. */
11450
11451 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
11452 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
11453 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
11454 breakpoint. */
11455
11456 std::vector<struct breakpoint *> found;
11457 for (const auto &sal : sals)
11458 {
11459 const char *sal_fullname;
11460
11461 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
11462 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
11463 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
11464 or at default pc.
11465
11466 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
11467
11468 0 1 pc
11469 1 1 pc _and_ line
11470 0 0 line
11471 1 0 <can't happen> */
11472
11473 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
11474 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
11475
11476 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
11477 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
11478 {
11479 int match = 0;
11480 /* Are we going to delete b? */
11481 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
11482 {
11483 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
11484 {
11485 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
11486 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
11487 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
11488 && sal.pc
11489 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
11490 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
11491 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
11492 || loc->section == sal.section));
11493 int line_match = 0;
11494
11495 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
11496 && loc->symtab != NULL
11497 && sal_fullname != NULL
11498 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
11499 && loc->line_number == sal.line
11500 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
11501 sal_fullname) == 0)
11502 line_match = 1;
11503
11504 if (pc_match || line_match)
11505 {
11506 match = 1;
11507 break;
11508 }
11509 }
11510 }
11511
11512 if (match)
11513 found.push_back (b);
11514 }
11515 }
11516
11517 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
11518 if (found.empty ())
11519 {
11520 if (arg)
11521 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
11522 else
11523 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
11524 }
11525
11526 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
11527 std::sort (found.begin (), found.end (),
11528 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11529 {
11530 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) < 0;
11531 });
11532 found.erase (std::unique (found.begin (), found.end (),
11533 [] (const breakpoint *bp_a, const breakpoint *bp_b)
11534 {
11535 return compare_breakpoints (bp_a, bp_b) == 0;
11536 }),
11537 found.end ());
11538
11539 if (found.size () > 1)
11540 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
11541 if (from_tty)
11542 {
11543 if (found.size () == 1)
11544 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
11545 else
11546 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
11547 }
11548
11549 for (breakpoint *iter : found)
11550 {
11551 if (from_tty)
11552 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", iter->number);
11553 delete_breakpoint (iter);
11554 }
11555 if (from_tty)
11556 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
11557 }
11558 \f
11559 /* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
11560 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
11561 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
11562
11563 void
11564 breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
11565 {
11566 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
11567 if (bs->breakpoint_at
11568 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
11569 && bs->stop)
11570 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
11571
11572 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
11573 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
11574 delete_breakpoint (b);
11575 }
11576
11577 /* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
11578 std::sort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
11579 bl_address_is_meaningful says), secondarily by ordering first
11580 permanent elements and terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted
11581 stable way despite std::sort being an unstable algorithm. */
11582
11583 static int
11584 bp_location_is_less_than (const bp_location *a, const bp_location *b)
11585 {
11586 if (a->address != b->address)
11587 return a->address < b->address;
11588
11589 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
11590 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
11591 grouped. */
11592
11593 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
11594 return a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num;
11595
11596 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
11597 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
11598 return a->permanent > b->permanent;
11599
11600 /* Sort by type in order to make duplicate determination easier.
11601 See update_global_location_list. This is kept in sync with
11602 breakpoint_locations_match. */
11603 if (a->loc_type < b->loc_type)
11604 return true;
11605
11606 /* Likewise, for range-breakpoints, sort by length. */
11607 if (a->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
11608 && b->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
11609 && a->length < b->length)
11610 return true;
11611
11612 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
11613 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
11614 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
11615
11616 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
11617 return a->owner->number < b->owner->number;
11618
11619 return a < b;
11620 }
11621
11622 /* Set bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max and
11623 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
11624 content of the bp_locations array. */
11625
11626 static void
11627 bp_locations_target_extensions_update (void)
11628 {
11629 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
11630 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
11631
11632 for (bp_location *bl : all_bp_locations ())
11633 {
11634 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
11635
11636 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
11637 continue;
11638
11639 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
11640 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
11641
11642 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
11643 addr = bl->address - start;
11644 if (addr > bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max)
11645 bp_locations_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
11646
11647 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
11648
11649 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
11650 addr = end - bl->address;
11651 if (addr > bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max)
11652 bp_locations_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
11653 }
11654 }
11655
11656 /* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
11657
11658 static void
11659 download_tracepoint_locations (void)
11660 {
11661 enum tribool can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN;
11662
11663 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
11664
11665 for (breakpoint *b : all_tracepoints ())
11666 {
11667 struct tracepoint *t;
11668 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
11669
11670 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
11671 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
11672 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
11673 continue;
11674
11675 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_UNKNOWN)
11676 {
11677 if (target_can_download_tracepoint ())
11678 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_TRUE;
11679 else
11680 can_download_tracepoint = TRIBOOL_FALSE;
11681 }
11682
11683 if (can_download_tracepoint == TRIBOOL_FALSE)
11684 break;
11685
11686 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
11687 {
11688 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
11689 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
11690 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
11691 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
11692 continue;
11693
11694 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
11695
11696 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
11697
11698 bl->inserted = 1;
11699 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
11700 }
11701 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
11702 t->number_on_target = b->number;
11703 if (bp_location_downloaded)
11704 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
11705 }
11706 }
11707
11708 /* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
11709
11710 static void
11711 swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
11712 {
11713 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
11714 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
11715 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
11716 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
11717
11718 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
11719 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
11720 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
11721 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
11722 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
11723
11724 left->inserted = right->inserted;
11725 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
11726 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
11727 left->target_info = right->target_info;
11728 right->inserted = left_inserted;
11729 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
11730 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
11731 right->target_info = left_target_info;
11732 }
11733
11734 /* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
11735 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
11736 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
11737 the target. */
11738
11739 static void
11740 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
11741 {
11742 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
11743 int pspace_num;
11744
11745 address = bl->address;
11746 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
11747
11748 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
11749 evaluating conditions and if the user has
11750 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
11751 side. */
11752 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
11753 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
11754 return;
11755
11756 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
11757 the same program space as the location
11758 as "its condition has changed". We need to
11759 update the conditions on the target's side. */
11760 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations_at_addr (address))
11761 {
11762 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
11763 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
11764 continue;
11765
11766 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
11767 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
11768 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
11769 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
11770 that have already been marked. */
11771 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
11772
11773 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
11774 it later on. */
11775 loc->cond_bytecode.reset ();
11776 }
11777 }
11778
11779 /* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
11780 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
11781 locations are duplicate of which.
11782
11783 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
11784 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
11785 info. */
11786
11787 static void
11788 update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
11789 {
11790 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
11791 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
11792 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
11793 int last_pspace_num = -1;
11794
11795 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
11796 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
11797 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
11798 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
11799 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
11800 once. */
11801 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
11802 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
11803 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
11804 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
11805
11806 /* Saved former bp_locations array which we compare against the newly
11807 built bp_locations from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
11808 std::vector<bp_location *> old_locations = std::move (bp_locations);
11809 bp_locations.clear ();
11810
11811 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
11812 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
11813 bp_locations.push_back (loc);
11814
11815 /* See if we need to "upgrade" a software breakpoint to a hardware
11816 breakpoint. Do this before deciding whether locations are
11817 duplicates. Also do this before sorting because sorting order
11818 depends on location type. */
11819 for (bp_location *loc : bp_locations)
11820 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
11821 handle_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (loc);
11822
11823 std::sort (bp_locations.begin (), bp_locations.end (),
11824 bp_location_is_less_than);
11825
11826 bp_locations_target_extensions_update ();
11827
11828 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
11829 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
11830 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
11831 if there's another location at the same address (previously
11832 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
11833 location.
11834
11835 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
11836 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
11837
11838 size_t loc_i = 0;
11839 for (bp_location *old_loc : old_locations)
11840 {
11841 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
11842 not, we have to free it. */
11843 int found_object = 0;
11844 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
11845 int keep_in_target = 0;
11846 int removed = 0;
11847
11848 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
11849 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
11850 while (loc_i < bp_locations.size ()
11851 && bp_locations[loc_i]->address < old_loc->address)
11852 loc_i++;
11853
11854 for (size_t loc2_i = loc_i;
11855 (loc2_i < bp_locations.size ()
11856 && bp_locations[loc2_i]->address == old_loc->address);
11857 loc2_i++)
11858 {
11859 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
11860 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
11861 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
11862 place there. */
11863 if (bp_locations[loc2_i]->condition_changed == condition_modified
11864 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
11865 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
11866 {
11867 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (bp_locations[loc2_i]);
11868 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
11869 }
11870
11871 if (bp_locations[loc2_i] == old_loc)
11872 found_object = 1;
11873 }
11874
11875 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
11876 have to go through updates again. */
11877 last_addr = old_loc->address;
11878
11879 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
11880 if (!found_object)
11881 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
11882
11883 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
11884 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
11885 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
11886 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
11887 at certain location is not inserted. */
11888
11889 if (old_loc->inserted)
11890 {
11891 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
11892 it. */
11893
11894 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
11895 {
11896 /* The location is still present in the location list,
11897 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
11898 keep_in_target = 1;
11899 }
11900 else
11901 {
11902 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
11903 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
11904 remove its target-side condition. */
11905
11906 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
11907 disabled. See if there's another location at the
11908 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
11909 this one from the target. */
11910
11911 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
11912 if (bl_address_is_meaningful (old_loc))
11913 {
11914 for (size_t loc2_i = loc_i;
11915 (loc2_i < bp_locations.size ()
11916 && bp_locations[loc2_i]->address == old_loc->address);
11917 loc2_i++)
11918 {
11919 bp_location *loc2 = bp_locations[loc2_i];
11920
11921 if (loc2 == old_loc)
11922 continue;
11923
11924 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
11925 {
11926 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
11927 access watchpoints, if the former are not
11928 supported, but the latter are. */
11929 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
11930 {
11931 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
11932 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
11933 }
11934
11935 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
11936 if it should be inserted in case it will be
11937 unduplicated. */
11938 if (unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
11939 {
11940 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
11941 keep_in_target = 1;
11942 break;
11943 }
11944 }
11945 }
11946 }
11947 }
11948
11949 if (!keep_in_target)
11950 {
11951 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc))
11952 {
11953 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
11954 this location on the global list, and try to
11955 remove it next time, but there's no particular
11956 reason why we will succeed next time.
11957
11958 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
11959 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
11960 only after calling us. */
11961 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
11962 "breakpoint %d\n"),
11963 old_loc->owner->number);
11964 }
11965 removed = 1;
11966 }
11967 }
11968
11969 if (!found_object)
11970 {
11971 if (removed && target_is_non_stop_p ()
11972 && need_moribund_for_location_type (old_loc))
11973 {
11974 /* This location was removed from the target. In
11975 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
11976 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
11977 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
11978 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
11979 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
11980 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
11981 after we see some number of events. The theory here
11982 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
11983 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
11984 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
11985 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
11986 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
11987 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
11988 SIGTRAP.
11989
11990 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
11991 decr_pc_after_break targets.
11992
11993 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
11994 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
11995 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
11996 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
11997 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
11998 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
11999 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
12000 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
12001 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
12002 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
12003 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
12004 targets that do not support new thread events, like
12005 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
12006 thread_count.
12007
12008 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
12009 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
12010 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
12011 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
12012
12013 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
12014 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
12015 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
12016 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
12017 traps we can no longer explain. */
12018
12019 process_stratum_target *proc_target = nullptr;
12020 for (inferior *inf : all_inferiors ())
12021 if (inf->pspace == old_loc->pspace)
12022 {
12023 proc_target = inf->process_target ();
12024 break;
12025 }
12026 if (proc_target != nullptr)
12027 old_loc->events_till_retirement
12028 = 3 * (thread_count (proc_target) + 1);
12029 else
12030 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 1;
12031 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12032
12033 moribund_locations.push_back (old_loc);
12034 }
12035 else
12036 {
12037 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12038 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12039 }
12040 }
12041 }
12042
12043 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12044 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12045 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12046 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12047 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12048 are sorted first for the same address.
12049
12050 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12051 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12052
12053 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12054 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12055 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12056 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12057
12058 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
12059 {
12060 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12061 non-NULL. */
12062 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12063 breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
12064
12065 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12066 || !bl_address_is_meaningful (loc)
12067 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12068 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12069 `struct bp_location'. */
12070 || is_tracepoint (b))
12071 {
12072 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12073 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12074 continue;
12075 }
12076
12077 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12078 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12079 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12080 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12081 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12082 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12083 else
12084 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12085
12086 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12087 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12088 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12089 {
12090 *loc_first_p = loc;
12091 loc->duplicate = 0;
12092
12093 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12094 {
12095 loc->needs_update = 1;
12096 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12097 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12098 }
12099 continue;
12100 }
12101
12102
12103 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12104 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12105 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12106 if (loc->inserted)
12107 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12108 loc->duplicate = 1;
12109
12110 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12111 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12112 }
12113
12114 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12115 {
12116 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12117 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12118 else
12119 {
12120 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12121 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12122 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12123 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12124 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12125 "needs_update". */
12126 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12127 }
12128 }
12129
12130 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12131 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12132 }
12133
12134 void
12135 breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12136 {
12137 for (int ix = 0; ix < moribund_locations.size (); ++ix)
12138 {
12139 struct bp_location *loc = moribund_locations[ix];
12140 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12141 {
12142 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12143 unordered_remove (moribund_locations, ix);
12144 --ix;
12145 }
12146 }
12147 }
12148
12149 static void
12150 update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12151 {
12152
12153 try
12154 {
12155 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12156 }
12157 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
12158 {
12159 }
12160 }
12161
12162 /* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12163
12164 static void
12165 bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12166 {
12167 bpstat bs;
12168
12169 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12170 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12171 {
12172 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12173 bs->old_val = NULL;
12174 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12175 }
12176 }
12177
12178 /* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12179 static int
12180 bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12181 {
12182 struct breakpoint *bpt = (struct breakpoint *) data;
12183
12184 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12185 return 0;
12186 }
12187
12188 /* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12189 callbacks. */
12190
12191 static void
12192 say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12193 {
12194 struct value_print_options opts;
12195
12196 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12197
12198 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12199 single string. */
12200 if (b->loc == NULL)
12201 {
12202 /* For pending locations, the output differs slightly based
12203 on b->extra_string. If this is non-NULL, it contains either
12204 a condition or dprintf arguments. */
12205 if (b->extra_string == NULL)
12206 {
12207 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."),
12208 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12209 }
12210 else if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
12211 {
12212 printf_filtered (_(" (%s,%s) pending."),
12213 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12214 b->extra_string);
12215 }
12216 else
12217 {
12218 printf_filtered (_(" (%s %s) pending."),
12219 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()),
12220 b->extra_string);
12221 }
12222 }
12223 else
12224 {
12225 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12226 printf_filtered (" at %ps",
12227 styled_string (address_style.style (),
12228 paddress (b->loc->gdbarch,
12229 b->loc->address)));
12230 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12231 {
12232 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12233 more nicely. */
12234 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12235 {
12236 const char *filename
12237 = symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab);
12238 printf_filtered (": file %ps, line %d.",
12239 styled_string (file_name_style.style (),
12240 filename),
12241 b->loc->line_number);
12242 }
12243 else
12244 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
12245 different file name, and this at least reflects the
12246 real situation somewhat. */
12247 printf_filtered (": %s.",
12248 event_location_to_string (b->location.get ()));
12249 }
12250
12251 if (b->loc->next)
12252 {
12253 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12254 int n = 0;
12255 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12256 ++n;
12257 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
12258 }
12259 }
12260 }
12261
12262 bp_location::~bp_location ()
12263 {
12264 xfree (function_name);
12265 }
12266
12267 /* Destructor for the breakpoint base class. */
12268
12269 breakpoint::~breakpoint ()
12270 {
12271 xfree (this->cond_string);
12272 xfree (this->extra_string);
12273 }
12274
12275 /* See breakpoint.h. */
12276
12277 bp_locations_range breakpoint::locations ()
12278 {
12279 return bp_locations_range (this->loc);
12280 }
12281
12282 static struct bp_location *
12283 base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
12284 {
12285 return new bp_location (self);
12286 }
12287
12288 static void
12289 base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12290 {
12291 /* Nothing to re-set. */
12292 }
12293
12294 #define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
12295 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
12296
12297 static int
12298 base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12299 {
12300 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12301 }
12302
12303 static int
12304 base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12305 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12306 {
12307 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12308 }
12309
12310 static int
12311 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12312 const address_space *aspace,
12313 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12314 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12315 {
12316 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12317 }
12318
12319 static void
12320 base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
12321 {
12322 /* Always stop. */
12323 }
12324
12325 /* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12326 errors. */
12327
12328 static int
12329 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
12330 {
12331 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12332 }
12333
12334 /* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
12335 errors. */
12336
12337 static int
12338 base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12339 {
12340 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12341 }
12342
12343 static enum print_stop_action
12344 base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
12345 {
12346 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12347 }
12348
12349 static void
12350 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12351 struct ui_out *uiout)
12352 {
12353 /* nothing */
12354 }
12355
12356 static void
12357 base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12358 {
12359 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12360 }
12361
12362 static void
12363 base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
12364 {
12365 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12366 }
12367
12368 static void
12369 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location
12370 (struct event_location *location,
12371 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12372 enum bptype type_wanted)
12373 {
12374 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12375 }
12376
12377 static void
12378 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12379 struct linespec_result *c,
12380 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12381 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12382 enum bptype type_wanted,
12383 enum bpdisp disposition,
12384 int thread,
12385 int task, int ignore_count,
12386 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
12387 int from_tty, int enabled,
12388 int internal, unsigned flags)
12389 {
12390 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12391 }
12392
12393 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12394 base_breakpoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12395 struct event_location *location,
12396 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12397 {
12398 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
12399 }
12400
12401 /* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
12402
12403 static int
12404 base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
12405 {
12406 return 1;
12407 }
12408
12409 /* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
12410
12411 static void
12412 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
12413 {
12414 /* Nothing to do. */
12415 }
12416
12417 struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
12418 {
12419 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
12420 base_breakpoint_re_set,
12421 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
12422 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
12423 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
12424 base_breakpoint_check_status,
12425 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
12426 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
12427 base_breakpoint_print_it,
12428 NULL,
12429 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
12430 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
12431 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
12432 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_location,
12433 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
12434 base_breakpoint_decode_location,
12435 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
12436 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
12437 };
12438
12439 /* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
12440
12441 static void
12442 bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12443 {
12444 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
12445 if (breakpoint_event_location_empty_p (b))
12446 {
12447 /* Anything without a location can't be re-set. */
12448 delete_breakpoint (b);
12449 return;
12450 }
12451
12452 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12453 }
12454
12455 static int
12456 bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12457 {
12458 CORE_ADDR addr = bl->target_info.reqstd_address;
12459
12460 bl->target_info.kind = breakpoint_kind (bl, &addr);
12461 bl->target_info.placed_address = addr;
12462
12463 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12464 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12465 else
12466 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12467 }
12468
12469 static int
12470 bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl, enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12471 {
12472 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
12473 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
12474 else
12475 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info, reason);
12476 }
12477
12478 static int
12479 bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12480 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12481 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12482 {
12483 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
12484 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
12485 return 0;
12486
12487 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
12488 aspace, bp_addr))
12489 return 0;
12490
12491 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
12492 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
12493 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
12494 return 0;
12495
12496 return 1;
12497 }
12498
12499 static int
12500 dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12501 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12502 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12503 {
12504 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
12505 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
12506 {
12507 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
12508 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
12509 be set at the same address. */
12510 return 0;
12511 }
12512
12513 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
12514 }
12515
12516 static int
12517 bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
12518 {
12519 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
12520
12521 return 1;
12522 }
12523
12524 static enum print_stop_action
12525 bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12526 {
12527 struct breakpoint *b;
12528 const struct bp_location *bl;
12529 int bp_temp;
12530 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
12531
12532 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
12533
12534 bl = bs->bp_location_at.get ();
12535 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12536
12537 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
12538 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
12539 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
12540 bl->address,
12541 b->number, 1);
12542 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
12543 maybe_print_thread_hit_breakpoint (uiout);
12544
12545 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12546 {
12547 uiout->field_string ("reason",
12548 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
12549 uiout->field_string ("disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
12550 }
12551 if (bp_temp)
12552 uiout->message ("Temporary breakpoint %pF, ",
12553 signed_field ("bkptno", b->number));
12554 else
12555 uiout->message ("Breakpoint %pF, ",
12556 signed_field ("bkptno", b->number));
12557
12558 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
12559 }
12560
12561 static void
12562 bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12563 {
12564 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12565 return;
12566
12567 switch (b->type)
12568 {
12569 case bp_breakpoint:
12570 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
12571 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
12572 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
12573 else
12574 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
12575 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12576 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
12577 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
12578 break;
12579 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
12580 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
12581 break;
12582 case bp_dprintf:
12583 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
12584 break;
12585 }
12586
12587 say_where (b);
12588 }
12589
12590 static void
12591 bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
12592 {
12593 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12594 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
12595 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
12596 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
12597 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
12598 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
12599 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
12600 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
12601 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
12602 else
12603 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12604 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
12605
12606 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12607 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()));
12608
12609 /* Print out extra_string if this breakpoint is pending. It might
12610 contain, for example, conditions that were set by the user. */
12611 if (tp->loc == NULL && tp->extra_string != NULL)
12612 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->extra_string);
12613
12614 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
12615 }
12616
12617 static void
12618 bkpt_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location,
12619 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12620 enum bptype type_wanted)
12621 {
12622 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12623 }
12624
12625 static void
12626 bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12627 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12628 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12629 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12630 enum bptype type_wanted,
12631 enum bpdisp disposition,
12632 int thread,
12633 int task, int ignore_count,
12634 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12635 int from_tty, int enabled,
12636 int internal, unsigned flags)
12637 {
12638 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12639 std::move (cond_string),
12640 std::move (extra_string),
12641 type_wanted,
12642 disposition, thread, task,
12643 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12644 enabled, internal, flags);
12645 }
12646
12647 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12648 bkpt_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12649 struct event_location *location,
12650 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12651 {
12652 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12653 }
12654
12655 /* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
12656
12657 static void
12658 internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12659 {
12660 switch (b->type)
12661 {
12662 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
12663 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
12664 case bp_overlay_event:
12665 case bp_longjmp_master:
12666 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12667 case bp_exception_master:
12668 delete_breakpoint (b);
12669 break;
12670
12671 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
12672 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
12673 case bp_shlib_event:
12674
12675 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
12676 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
12677 case bp_thread_event:
12678 break;
12679 }
12680 }
12681
12682 static void
12683 internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12684 {
12685 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
12686 {
12687 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
12688 events. This allows the user to get control and place
12689 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
12690 objects (among other things). */
12691 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
12692 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
12693 }
12694 else
12695 bs->stop = 0;
12696 }
12697
12698 static enum print_stop_action
12699 internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12700 {
12701 struct breakpoint *b;
12702
12703 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
12704
12705 switch (b->type)
12706 {
12707 case bp_shlib_event:
12708 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
12709 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
12710 to shlib event" message.) */
12711 print_solib_event (0);
12712 break;
12713
12714 case bp_thread_event:
12715 /* Not sure how we will get here.
12716 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
12717 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12718 break;
12719
12720 case bp_overlay_event:
12721 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
12722 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12723 break;
12724
12725 case bp_longjmp_master:
12726 /* These should never be enabled. */
12727 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
12728 break;
12729
12730 case bp_std_terminate_master:
12731 /* These should never be enabled. */
12732 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
12733 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12734 break;
12735
12736 case bp_exception_master:
12737 /* These should never be enabled. */
12738 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
12739 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
12740 break;
12741 }
12742
12743 return PRINT_NOTHING;
12744 }
12745
12746 static void
12747 internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12748 {
12749 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12750 }
12751
12752 /* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
12753
12754 static void
12755 momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12756 {
12757 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
12758 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
12759 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
12760 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
12761 }
12762
12763 static void
12764 momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
12765 {
12766 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
12767 }
12768
12769 static enum print_stop_action
12770 momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
12771 {
12772 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
12773 }
12774
12775 static void
12776 momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12777 {
12778 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
12779 }
12780
12781 /* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
12782
12783 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
12784 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
12785
12786 longjmp_breakpoint::~longjmp_breakpoint ()
12787 {
12788 thread_info *tp = find_thread_global_id (this->thread);
12789
12790 if (tp != NULL)
12791 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
12792 }
12793
12794 /* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
12795
12796 static int
12797 bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
12798 {
12799 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
12800
12801 if (v == 0)
12802 {
12803 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
12804 if needed. */
12805 bl->probe.prob->set_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12806 }
12807
12808 return v;
12809 }
12810
12811 static int
12812 bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl,
12813 enum remove_bp_reason reason)
12814 {
12815 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
12816 bl->probe.prob->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.objfile, bl->gdbarch);
12817
12818 return bkpt_remove_location (bl, reason);
12819 }
12820
12821 static void
12822 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location,
12823 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12824 enum bptype type_wanted)
12825 {
12826 struct linespec_sals lsal;
12827
12828 lsal.sals = parse_probes (location, NULL, canonical);
12829 lsal.canonical
12830 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
12831 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
12832 }
12833
12834 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12835 bkpt_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12836 struct event_location *location,
12837 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12838 {
12839 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = parse_probes (location, search_pspace, NULL);
12840 if (sals.empty ())
12841 error (_("probe not found"));
12842 return sals;
12843 }
12844
12845 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
12846
12847 static void
12848 tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12849 {
12850 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12851 }
12852
12853 static int
12854 tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
12855 const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
12856 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
12857 {
12858 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
12859 tracepoints. */
12860 return 0;
12861 }
12862
12863 static void
12864 tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
12865 struct ui_out *uiout)
12866 {
12867 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12868 if (!tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
12869 {
12870 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
12871
12872 uiout->message ("\tmarker id is %pF\n",
12873 string_field ("static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
12874 tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ()));
12875 }
12876 }
12877
12878 static void
12879 tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
12880 {
12881 if (current_uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
12882 return;
12883
12884 switch (b->type)
12885 {
12886 case bp_tracepoint:
12887 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
12888 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12889 break;
12890 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
12891 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
12892 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12893 break;
12894 case bp_static_tracepoint:
12895 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
12896 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
12897 break;
12898 default:
12899 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12900 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
12901 }
12902
12903 say_where (b);
12904 }
12905
12906 static void
12907 tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
12908 {
12909 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
12910
12911 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
12912 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
12913 else if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
12914 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
12915 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
12916 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
12917 else
12918 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12919 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
12920
12921 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s",
12922 event_location_to_string (self->location.get ()));
12923 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
12924
12925 if (tp->pass_count)
12926 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
12927 }
12928
12929 static void
12930 tracepoint_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location,
12931 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12932 enum bptype type_wanted)
12933 {
12934 create_sals_from_location_default (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12935 }
12936
12937 static void
12938 tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
12939 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12940 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
12941 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
12942 enum bptype type_wanted,
12943 enum bpdisp disposition,
12944 int thread,
12945 int task, int ignore_count,
12946 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12947 int from_tty, int enabled,
12948 int internal, unsigned flags)
12949 {
12950 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
12951 std::move (cond_string),
12952 std::move (extra_string),
12953 type_wanted,
12954 disposition, thread, task,
12955 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
12956 enabled, internal, flags);
12957 }
12958
12959 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12960 tracepoint_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12961 struct event_location *location,
12962 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12963 {
12964 return decode_location_default (b, location, search_pspace);
12965 }
12966
12967 struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
12968
12969 /* Virtual table for tracepoints on static probes. */
12970
12971 static void
12972 tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location
12973 (struct event_location *location,
12974 struct linespec_result *canonical,
12975 enum bptype type_wanted)
12976 {
12977 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12978 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location (location, canonical, type_wanted);
12979 }
12980
12981 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
12982 tracepoint_probe_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
12983 struct event_location *location,
12984 struct program_space *search_pspace)
12985 {
12986 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
12987 return bkpt_probe_decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
12988 }
12989
12990 /* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
12991
12992 static void
12993 dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
12994 {
12995 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
12996
12997 /* extra_string should never be non-NULL for dprintf. */
12998 gdb_assert (b->extra_string != NULL);
12999
13000 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
13001 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
13002 3 - disconnect from target 1
13003 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
13004
13005 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
13006 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
13007 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
13008 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
13009 it all the time. */
13010 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
13011 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
13012 }
13013
13014 /* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
13015
13016 static void
13017 dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13018 {
13019 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s,%s",
13020 event_location_to_string (tp->location.get ()),
13021 tp->extra_string);
13022 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13023 }
13024
13025 /* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
13026 dprintf.
13027
13028 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
13029 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
13030 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
13031 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
13032 address are all handled. */
13033
13034 static void
13035 dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13036 {
13037 struct bpstats tmp_bs;
13038 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13039
13040 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13041 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13042 condition not be evaluated. */
13043 bs->stop = 0;
13044
13045 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13046 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13047 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13048 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13049 commands here throws. */
13050 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13051 bs->commands = NULL;
13052
13053 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13054
13055 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13056 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13057 list. */
13058 }
13059
13060 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13061 markers (`-m'). */
13062
13063 static void
13064 strace_marker_create_sals_from_location (struct event_location *location,
13065 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13066 enum bptype type_wanted)
13067 {
13068 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13069 const char *arg_start, *arg;
13070
13071 arg = arg_start = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13072 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&arg);
13073
13074 std::string str (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
13075 const char *ptr = str.c_str ();
13076 canonical->location
13077 = new_linespec_location (&ptr, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
13078
13079 lsal.canonical
13080 = xstrdup (event_location_to_string (canonical->location.get ()));
13081 canonical->lsals.push_back (std::move (lsal));
13082 }
13083
13084 static void
13085 strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13086 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13087 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13088 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13089 enum bptype type_wanted,
13090 enum bpdisp disposition,
13091 int thread,
13092 int task, int ignore_count,
13093 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13094 int from_tty, int enabled,
13095 int internal, unsigned flags)
13096 {
13097 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical->lsals[0];
13098
13099 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13100 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13101 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13102 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13103 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13104 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13105
13106 for (size_t i = 0; i < lsal.sals.size (); i++)
13107 {
13108 event_location_up location
13109 = copy_event_location (canonical->location.get ());
13110
13111 std::unique_ptr<tracepoint> tp (new tracepoint ());
13112 init_breakpoint_sal (tp.get (), gdbarch, lsal.sals[i],
13113 std::move (location), NULL,
13114 std::move (cond_string),
13115 std::move (extra_string),
13116 type_wanted, disposition,
13117 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13118 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13119 canonical->special_display);
13120 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13121 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13122 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13123 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13124 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13125 corresponds to this one */
13126 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13127
13128 install_breakpoint (internal, std::move (tp), 0);
13129 }
13130 }
13131
13132 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13133 strace_marker_decode_location (struct breakpoint *b,
13134 struct event_location *location,
13135 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13136 {
13137 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13138 const char *s = get_linespec_location (location)->spec_string;
13139
13140 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (&s);
13141 if (sals.size () > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13142 {
13143 sals[0] = sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13144 sals.resize (1);
13145 return sals;
13146 }
13147 else
13148 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13149 }
13150
13151 static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13152
13153 static int
13154 strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13155 {
13156 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13157 }
13158
13159 /* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13160 structures. */
13161
13162 void
13163 delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13164 {
13165 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13166
13167 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13168 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13169 especial culprits.
13170
13171 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13172 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13173 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13174 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13175 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13176 deleted.
13177
13178 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13179 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13180 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13181 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13182 was chosen. */
13183 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13184 return;
13185
13186 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13187 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13188 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13189 {
13190 struct breakpoint *related;
13191 struct watchpoint *w;
13192
13193 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13194 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
13195 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
13196 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
13197 else
13198 w = NULL;
13199 if (w != NULL)
13200 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
13201
13202 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
13203 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
13204 related = related->related_breakpoint);
13205 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
13206 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
13207 }
13208
13209 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
13210 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
13211 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
13212 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
13213 if (bpt->number)
13214 gdb::observers::breakpoint_deleted.notify (bpt);
13215
13216 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
13217 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
13218
13219 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
13220 if (b->next == bpt)
13221 {
13222 b->next = bpt->next;
13223 break;
13224 }
13225
13226 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
13227 been freed. */
13228 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
13229 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
13230 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
13231 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
13232 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
13233 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
13234 commands won't work. */
13235
13236 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
13237
13238 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
13239 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
13240 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
13241 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
13242 might be better design to have location completely
13243 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
13244 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
13245
13246 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
13247 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
13248 bpt->type = bp_none;
13249 delete bpt;
13250 }
13251
13252 /* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
13253 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
13254
13255 static void
13256 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
13257 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
13258 {
13259 struct breakpoint *related;
13260
13261 related = b;
13262 do
13263 {
13264 struct breakpoint *next;
13265
13266 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
13267 next = related->related_breakpoint;
13268
13269 if (next == related)
13270 {
13271 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
13272 function (related);
13273
13274 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
13275 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
13276 out. */
13277 break;
13278 }
13279 else
13280 function (related);
13281
13282 related = next;
13283 }
13284 while (related != b);
13285 }
13286
13287 static void
13288 delete_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
13289 {
13290 dont_repeat ();
13291
13292 if (arg == 0)
13293 {
13294 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
13295
13296 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
13297 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
13298 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
13299 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
13300 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13301 {
13302 breaks_to_delete = 1;
13303 break;
13304 }
13305
13306 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
13307 if (!from_tty
13308 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
13309 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
13310 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
13311 delete_breakpoint (b);
13312 }
13313 else
13314 map_breakpoint_numbers
13315 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
13316 {
13317 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
13318 });
13319 }
13320
13321 /* Return true if all locations of B bound to PSPACE are pending. If
13322 PSPACE is NULL, all locations of all program spaces are
13323 considered. */
13324
13325 static int
13326 all_locations_are_pending (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13327 {
13328 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
13329 if ((pspace == NULL
13330 || loc->pspace == pspace)
13331 && !loc->shlib_disabled
13332 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13333 return 0;
13334 return 1;
13335 }
13336
13337 /* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
13338 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
13339 Null names are ignored. */
13340
13341 static int
13342 ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
13343 {
13344 struct bp_location *l;
13345 htab_up htab (htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string, htab_eq_string, NULL,
13346 xcalloc, xfree));
13347
13348 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
13349 {
13350 const char **slot;
13351 const char *name = l->function_name;
13352
13353 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
13354 if (name == NULL)
13355 continue;
13356
13357 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab.get (), (const void *) name,
13358 INSERT);
13359 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
13360 returns NULL. */
13361 if (*slot != NULL)
13362 return 1;
13363 *slot = name;
13364 }
13365
13366 return 0;
13367 }
13368
13369 /* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
13370 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
13371 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
13372 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
13373 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
13374 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
13375 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
13376 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
13377 The heuristic is:
13378
13379 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
13380 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
13381 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
13382 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
13383 in the sources, and output a warning.
13384
13385 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
13386 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
13387 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
13388 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
13389 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
13390 warning.
13391
13392 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
13393 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
13394 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
13395 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
13396 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
13397 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
13398 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
13399 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
13400 precisely because it confuses tools). */
13401
13402 static struct symtab_and_line
13403 update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
13404 {
13405 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13406 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
13407 CORE_ADDR pc;
13408
13409 pc = sal.pc;
13410 if (sal.line)
13411 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
13412
13413 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
13414 {
13415 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id != marker.str_id)
13416 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
13417 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str (),
13418 marker.str_id.c_str ());
13419
13420 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (marker.str_id);
13421
13422 return sal;
13423 }
13424
13425 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
13426 by string ID. */
13427 if (!sal.explicit_pc
13428 && sal.line != 0
13429 && sal.symtab != NULL
13430 && !tp->static_trace_marker_id.empty ())
13431 {
13432 std::vector<static_tracepoint_marker> markers
13433 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid
13434 (tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13435
13436 if (!markers.empty ())
13437 {
13438 struct symbol *sym;
13439 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
13440 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13441 struct explicit_location explicit_loc;
13442
13443 tpmarker = &markers[0];
13444
13445 tp->static_trace_marker_id = std::move (tpmarker->str_id);
13446
13447 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
13448 "found at previous line number"),
13449 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id.c_str ());
13450
13451 symtab_and_line sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
13452 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
13453 uiout->text ("Now in ");
13454 if (sym)
13455 {
13456 uiout->field_string ("func", sym->print_name (),
13457 function_name_style.style ());
13458 uiout->text (" at ");
13459 }
13460 uiout->field_string ("file",
13461 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab),
13462 file_name_style.style ());
13463 uiout->text (":");
13464
13465 if (uiout->is_mi_like_p ())
13466 {
13467 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
13468
13469 uiout->field_string ("fullname", fullname);
13470 }
13471
13472 uiout->field_signed ("line", sal2.line);
13473 uiout->text ("\n");
13474
13475 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
13476 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
13477
13478 b->location.reset (NULL);
13479 initialize_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13480 explicit_loc.source_filename
13481 = ASTRDUP (symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
13482 explicit_loc.line_offset.offset = b->loc->line_number;
13483 explicit_loc.line_offset.sign = LINE_OFFSET_NONE;
13484 b->location = new_explicit_location (&explicit_loc);
13485
13486 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
13487 so. */
13488 }
13489 }
13490 return sal;
13491 }
13492
13493 /* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
13494 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
13495
13496 static int
13497 locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
13498 {
13499 while (a && b)
13500 {
13501 if (a->address != b->address)
13502 return 0;
13503
13504 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
13505 return 0;
13506
13507 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
13508 return 0;
13509
13510 if (a->disabled_by_cond != b->disabled_by_cond)
13511 return 0;
13512
13513 a = a->next;
13514 b = b->next;
13515 }
13516
13517 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
13518 return 0;
13519
13520 return 1;
13521 }
13522
13523 /* Split all locations of B that are bound to PSPACE out of B's
13524 location list to a separate list and return that list's head. If
13525 PSPACE is NULL, hoist out all locations of B. */
13526
13527 static struct bp_location *
13528 hoist_existing_locations (struct breakpoint *b, struct program_space *pspace)
13529 {
13530 struct bp_location head;
13531 struct bp_location *i = b->loc;
13532 struct bp_location **i_link = &b->loc;
13533 struct bp_location *hoisted = &head;
13534
13535 if (pspace == NULL)
13536 {
13537 i = b->loc;
13538 b->loc = NULL;
13539 return i;
13540 }
13541
13542 head.next = NULL;
13543
13544 while (i != NULL)
13545 {
13546 if (i->pspace == pspace)
13547 {
13548 *i_link = i->next;
13549 i->next = NULL;
13550 hoisted->next = i;
13551 hoisted = i;
13552 }
13553 else
13554 i_link = &i->next;
13555 i = *i_link;
13556 }
13557
13558 return head.next;
13559 }
13560
13561 /* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software
13562 breakpoint) based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not
13563 zero, then B is a ranged breakpoint. Only recreates locations for
13564 FILTER_PSPACE. Locations of other program spaces are left
13565 untouched. */
13566
13567 void
13568 update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
13569 struct program_space *filter_pspace,
13570 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals,
13571 gdb::array_view<const symtab_and_line> sals_end)
13572 {
13573 struct bp_location *existing_locations;
13574
13575 if (!sals_end.empty () && (sals.size () != 1 || sals_end.size () != 1))
13576 {
13577 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
13578 location. */
13579 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13580 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
13581 "multiple locations found\n"),
13582 b->number);
13583 return;
13584 }
13585
13586 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
13587 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
13588 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
13589 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
13590 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
13591 individual locations. */
13592 if (all_locations_are_pending (b, filter_pspace) && sals.empty ())
13593 return;
13594
13595 existing_locations = hoist_existing_locations (b, filter_pspace);
13596
13597 for (const auto &sal : sals)
13598 {
13599 struct bp_location *new_loc;
13600
13601 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal.pspace);
13602
13603 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
13604
13605 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
13606 old symtab. */
13607 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
13608 {
13609 const char *s;
13610
13611 s = b->cond_string;
13612 try
13613 {
13614 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sal.pc,
13615 block_for_pc (sal.pc),
13616 0);
13617 }
13618 catch (const gdb_exception_error &e)
13619 {
13620 new_loc->disabled_by_cond = true;
13621 }
13622 }
13623
13624 if (!sals_end.empty ())
13625 {
13626 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end[0]);
13627
13628 new_loc->length = end - sals[0].pc + 1;
13629 }
13630 }
13631
13632 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
13633 breakpoints. */
13634 {
13635 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
13636 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
13637 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
13638 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
13639 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
13640 often enough until a better solution is found. */
13641 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
13642
13643 for (; e; e = e->next)
13644 {
13645 if ((!e->enabled || e->disabled_by_cond) && e->function_name)
13646 {
13647 if (have_ambiguous_names)
13648 {
13649 for (bp_location *l : b->locations ())
13650 {
13651 /* Ignore software vs hardware location type at
13652 this point, because with "set breakpoint
13653 auto-hw", after a re-set, locations that were
13654 hardware can end up as software, or vice versa.
13655 As mentioned above, this is an heuristic and in
13656 practice should give the correct answer often
13657 enough. */
13658 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l, true))
13659 {
13660 l->enabled = e->enabled;
13661 l->disabled_by_cond = e->disabled_by_cond;
13662 break;
13663 }
13664 }
13665 }
13666 else
13667 {
13668 for (bp_location *l : b->locations ())
13669 if (l->function_name
13670 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
13671 {
13672 l->enabled = e->enabled;
13673 l->disabled_by_cond = e->disabled_by_cond;
13674 break;
13675 }
13676 }
13677 }
13678 }
13679 }
13680
13681 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
13682 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13683 }
13684
13685 /* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given LOCATION.
13686 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
13687
13688 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13689 location_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, struct event_location *location,
13690 struct program_space *search_pspace, int *found)
13691 {
13692 struct gdb_exception exception;
13693
13694 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
13695
13696 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals;
13697
13698 try
13699 {
13700 sals = b->ops->decode_location (b, location, search_pspace);
13701 }
13702 catch (gdb_exception_error &e)
13703 {
13704 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
13705
13706 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
13707 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
13708 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
13709 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
13710 state, then user already saw the message about that
13711 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
13712 errors. */
13713 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
13714 && (b->condition_not_parsed
13715 || (b->loc != NULL
13716 && search_pspace != NULL
13717 && b->loc->pspace != search_pspace)
13718 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
13719 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
13720 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
13721 not_found_and_ok = 1;
13722
13723 if (!not_found_and_ok)
13724 {
13725 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
13726 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
13727 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
13728 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
13729 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
13730 which approach is better. */
13731 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
13732 throw;
13733 }
13734
13735 exception = std::move (e);
13736 }
13737
13738 if (exception.reason == 0 || exception.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
13739 {
13740 for (auto &sal : sals)
13741 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
13742 if (b->condition_not_parsed && b->extra_string != NULL)
13743 {
13744 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
13745 int thread, task;
13746
13747 find_condition_and_thread_for_sals (sals, b->extra_string,
13748 &cond_string, &thread,
13749 &task, &extra_string);
13750 gdb_assert (b->cond_string == NULL);
13751 if (cond_string)
13752 b->cond_string = cond_string;
13753 b->thread = thread;
13754 b->task = task;
13755 if (extra_string)
13756 {
13757 xfree (b->extra_string);
13758 b->extra_string = extra_string;
13759 }
13760 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
13761 }
13762
13763 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
13764 sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals[0]);
13765
13766 *found = 1;
13767 }
13768 else
13769 *found = 0;
13770
13771 return sals;
13772 }
13773
13774 /* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
13775 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
13776 locations. */
13777
13778 static void
13779 breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
13780 {
13781 struct program_space *filter_pspace = current_program_space;
13782 std::vector<symtab_and_line> expanded, expanded_end;
13783
13784 int found;
13785 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals = location_to_sals (b, b->location.get (),
13786 filter_pspace, &found);
13787 if (found)
13788 expanded = std::move (sals);
13789
13790 if (b->location_range_end != NULL)
13791 {
13792 std::vector<symtab_and_line> sals_end
13793 = location_to_sals (b, b->location_range_end.get (),
13794 filter_pspace, &found);
13795 if (found)
13796 expanded_end = std::move (sals_end);
13797 }
13798
13799 update_breakpoint_locations (b, filter_pspace, expanded, expanded_end);
13800 }
13801
13802 /* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
13803 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
13804
13805 static void
13806 create_sals_from_location_default (struct event_location *location,
13807 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13808 enum bptype type_wanted)
13809 {
13810 parse_breakpoint_sals (location, canonical);
13811 }
13812
13813 /* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
13814 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
13815 breakpoint_ops. */
13816
13817 static void
13818 create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13819 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13820 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> cond_string,
13821 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> extra_string,
13822 enum bptype type_wanted,
13823 enum bpdisp disposition,
13824 int thread,
13825 int task, int ignore_count,
13826 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13827 int from_tty, int enabled,
13828 int internal, unsigned flags)
13829 {
13830 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical,
13831 std::move (cond_string),
13832 std::move (extra_string),
13833 type_wanted, disposition,
13834 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13835 enabled, internal, flags);
13836 }
13837
13838 /* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
13839 default function for the `decode_location' method of breakpoint_ops. */
13840
13841 static std::vector<symtab_and_line>
13842 decode_location_default (struct breakpoint *b,
13843 struct event_location *location,
13844 struct program_space *search_pspace)
13845 {
13846 struct linespec_result canonical;
13847
13848 decode_line_full (location, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE, search_pspace,
13849 NULL, 0, &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
13850 b->filter.get ());
13851
13852 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
13853 gdb_assert (canonical.lsals.size () < 2);
13854
13855 if (!canonical.lsals.empty ())
13856 {
13857 const linespec_sals &lsal = canonical.lsals[0];
13858 return std::move (lsal.sals);
13859 }
13860 return {};
13861 }
13862
13863 /* Reset a breakpoint. */
13864
13865 static void
13866 breakpoint_re_set_one (breakpoint *b)
13867 {
13868 input_radix = b->input_radix;
13869 set_language (b->language);
13870
13871 b->ops->re_set (b);
13872 }
13873
13874 /* Re-set breakpoint locations for the current program space.
13875 Locations bound to other program spaces are left untouched. */
13876
13877 void
13878 breakpoint_re_set (void)
13879 {
13880 {
13881 scoped_restore_current_language save_language;
13882 scoped_restore save_input_radix = make_scoped_restore (&input_radix);
13883 scoped_restore_current_pspace_and_thread restore_pspace_thread;
13884
13885 /* breakpoint_re_set_one sets the current_language to the language
13886 of the breakpoint it is resetting (see prepare_re_set_context)
13887 before re-evaluating the breakpoint's location. This change can
13888 unfortunately get undone by accident if the language_mode is set
13889 to auto, and we either switch frames, or more likely in this context,
13890 we select the current frame.
13891
13892 We prevent this by temporarily turning the language_mode to
13893 language_mode_manual. We restore it once all breakpoints
13894 have been reset. */
13895 scoped_restore save_language_mode = make_scoped_restore (&language_mode);
13896 language_mode = language_mode_manual;
13897
13898 /* Note: we must not try to insert locations until after all
13899 breakpoints have been re-set. Otherwise, e.g., when re-setting
13900 breakpoint 1, we'd insert the locations of breakpoint 2, which
13901 hadn't been re-set yet, and thus may have stale locations. */
13902
13903 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
13904 {
13905 try
13906 {
13907 breakpoint_re_set_one (b);
13908 }
13909 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
13910 {
13911 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, ex,
13912 "Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
13913 b->number);
13914 }
13915 }
13916
13917 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
13918 }
13919
13920 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
13921 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
13922 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
13923 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
13924
13925 /* Now we can insert. */
13926 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
13927 }
13928 \f
13929 /* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
13930
13931 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
13932 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
13933 void
13934 breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
13935 {
13936 if (b->thread != -1)
13937 {
13938 b->thread = inferior_thread ()->global_num;
13939
13940 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
13941 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
13942 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
13943 as well. */
13944 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
13945 }
13946 }
13947
13948 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
13949 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
13950 which ends with a period (no newline). */
13951
13952 void
13953 set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
13954 {
13955 if (count < 0)
13956 count = 0;
13957
13958 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
13959 if (b->number == bptnum)
13960 {
13961 if (is_tracepoint (b))
13962 {
13963 if (from_tty && count != 0)
13964 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
13965 bptnum);
13966 return;
13967 }
13968
13969 b->ignore_count = count;
13970 if (from_tty)
13971 {
13972 if (count == 0)
13973 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
13974 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
13975 bptnum);
13976 else if (count == 1)
13977 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
13978 bptnum);
13979 else
13980 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
13981 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
13982 count, bptnum);
13983 }
13984 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (b);
13985 return;
13986 }
13987
13988 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
13989 }
13990
13991 /* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
13992
13993 static void
13994 ignore_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
13995 {
13996 const char *p = args;
13997 int num;
13998
13999 if (p == 0)
14000 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
14001
14002 num = get_number (&p);
14003 if (num == 0)
14004 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
14005 if (*p == 0)
14006 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
14007
14008 set_ignore_count (num,
14009 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
14010 from_tty);
14011 if (from_tty)
14012 printf_filtered ("\n");
14013 }
14014 \f
14015
14016 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints with numbers in the range
14017 defined by BP_NUM_RANGE (an inclusive range). */
14018
14019 static void
14020 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range,
14021 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
14022 {
14023 if (bp_num_range.first == 0)
14024 {
14025 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%d'"),
14026 bp_num_range.first);
14027 }
14028 else
14029 {
14030 for (int i = bp_num_range.first; i <= bp_num_range.second; i++)
14031 {
14032 bool match = false;
14033
14034 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
14035 if (b->number == i)
14036 {
14037 match = true;
14038 function (b);
14039 break;
14040 }
14041 if (!match)
14042 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), i);
14043 }
14044 }
14045 }
14046
14047 /* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints whose numbers are given in
14048 ARGS. */
14049
14050 static void
14051 map_breakpoint_numbers (const char *args,
14052 gdb::function_view<void (breakpoint *)> function)
14053 {
14054 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14055 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14056
14057 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14058
14059 while (!parser.finished ())
14060 {
14061 int num = parser.get_number ();
14062 map_breakpoint_number_range (std::make_pair (num, num), function);
14063 }
14064 }
14065
14066 /* Return the breakpoint location structure corresponding to the
14067 BP_NUM and LOC_NUM values. */
14068
14069 static struct bp_location *
14070 find_location_by_number (int bp_num, int loc_num)
14071 {
14072 breakpoint *b = get_breakpoint (bp_num);
14073
14074 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14075 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%d'"), bp_num);
14076
14077 if (loc_num == 0)
14078 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14079
14080 int n = 0;
14081 for (bp_location *loc : b->locations ())
14082 if (++n == loc_num)
14083 return loc;
14084
14085 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%d'"), loc_num);
14086 }
14087
14088 /* Modes of operation for extract_bp_num. */
14089 enum class extract_bp_kind
14090 {
14091 /* Extracting a breakpoint number. */
14092 bp,
14093
14094 /* Extracting a location number. */
14095 loc,
14096 };
14097
14098 /* Extract a breakpoint or location number (as determined by KIND)
14099 from the string starting at START. TRAILER is a character which
14100 can be found after the number. If you don't want a trailer, use
14101 '\0'. If END_OUT is not NULL, it is set to point after the parsed
14102 string. This always returns a positive integer. */
14103
14104 static int
14105 extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind kind, const char *start,
14106 int trailer, const char **end_out = NULL)
14107 {
14108 const char *end = start;
14109 int num = get_number_trailer (&end, trailer);
14110 if (num < 0)
14111 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14112 ? _("Negative breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14113 : _("Negative breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14114 int (end - start), start);
14115 if (num == 0)
14116 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14117 ? _("Bad breakpoint number '%.*s'")
14118 : _("Bad breakpoint location number '%.*s'"),
14119 int (end - start), start);
14120
14121 if (end_out != NULL)
14122 *end_out = end;
14123 return num;
14124 }
14125
14126 /* Extract a breakpoint or location range (as determined by KIND) in
14127 the form NUM1-NUM2 stored at &ARG[arg_offset]. Returns a std::pair
14128 representing the (inclusive) range. The returned pair's elements
14129 are always positive integers. */
14130
14131 static std::pair<int, int>
14132 extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind kind,
14133 const std::string &arg,
14134 std::string::size_type arg_offset)
14135 {
14136 std::pair<int, int> range;
14137 const char *bp_loc = &arg[arg_offset];
14138 std::string::size_type dash = arg.find ('-', arg_offset);
14139 if (dash != std::string::npos)
14140 {
14141 /* bp_loc is a range (x-z). */
14142 if (arg.length () == dash + 1)
14143 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14144 ? _("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'")
14145 : _("Bad breakpoint location number at or near: '%s'"),
14146 bp_loc);
14147
14148 const char *end;
14149 const char *start_first = bp_loc;
14150 const char *start_second = &arg[dash + 1];
14151 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, start_first, '-');
14152 range.second = extract_bp_num (kind, start_second, '\0', &end);
14153
14154 if (range.first > range.second)
14155 error (kind == extract_bp_kind::bp
14156 ? _("Inverted breakpoint range at '%.*s'")
14157 : _("Inverted breakpoint location range at '%.*s'"),
14158 int (end - start_first), start_first);
14159 }
14160 else
14161 {
14162 /* bp_loc is a single value. */
14163 range.first = extract_bp_num (kind, bp_loc, '\0');
14164 range.second = range.first;
14165 }
14166 return range;
14167 }
14168
14169 /* Extract the breakpoint/location range specified by ARG. Returns
14170 the breakpoint range in BP_NUM_RANGE, and the location range in
14171 BP_LOC_RANGE.
14172
14173 ARG may be in any of the following forms:
14174
14175 x where 'x' is a breakpoint number.
14176 x-y where 'x' and 'y' specify a breakpoint numbers range.
14177 x.y where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' a location number.
14178 x.y-z where 'x' is a breakpoint number and 'y' and 'z' specify a
14179 location number range.
14180 */
14181
14182 static void
14183 extract_bp_number_and_location (const std::string &arg,
14184 std::pair<int, int> &bp_num_range,
14185 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range)
14186 {
14187 std::string::size_type dot = arg.find ('.');
14188
14189 if (dot != std::string::npos)
14190 {
14191 /* Handle 'x.y' and 'x.y-z' cases. */
14192
14193 if (arg.length () == dot + 1 || dot == 0)
14194 error (_("Bad breakpoint number at or near: '%s'"), arg.c_str ());
14195
14196 bp_num_range.first
14197 = extract_bp_num (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg.c_str (), '.');
14198 bp_num_range.second = bp_num_range.first;
14199
14200 bp_loc_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::loc,
14201 arg, dot + 1);
14202 }
14203 else
14204 {
14205 /* Handle x and x-y cases. */
14206
14207 bp_num_range = extract_bp_or_bp_range (extract_bp_kind::bp, arg, 0);
14208 bp_loc_range.first = 0;
14209 bp_loc_range.second = 0;
14210 }
14211 }
14212
14213 /* Enable or disable a breakpoint location BP_NUM.LOC_NUM. ENABLE
14214 specifies whether to enable or disable. */
14215
14216 static void
14217 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (int bp_num, int loc_num, bool enable)
14218 {
14219 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (bp_num, loc_num);
14220 if (loc != NULL)
14221 {
14222 if (loc->disabled_by_cond && enable)
14223 error (_("Breakpoint %d's condition is invalid at location %d, "
14224 "cannot enable."), bp_num, loc_num);
14225
14226 if (loc->enabled != enable)
14227 {
14228 loc->enabled = enable;
14229 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14230 }
14231 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14232 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14233 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14234 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14235 }
14236 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14237
14238 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (loc->owner);
14239 }
14240
14241 /* Enable or disable a range of breakpoint locations. BP_NUM is the
14242 number of the breakpoint, and BP_LOC_RANGE specifies the
14243 (inclusive) range of location numbers of that breakpoint to
14244 enable/disable. ENABLE specifies whether to enable or disable the
14245 location. */
14246
14247 static void
14248 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range (int bp_num,
14249 std::pair<int, int> &bp_loc_range,
14250 bool enable)
14251 {
14252 for (int i = bp_loc_range.first; i <= bp_loc_range.second; i++)
14253 enable_disable_bp_num_loc (bp_num, i, enable);
14254 }
14255
14256 /* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14257 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14258 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14259
14260 void
14261 disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14262 {
14263 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14264 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14265 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14266 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14267 return;
14268
14269 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14270
14271 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14272 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14273
14274 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14275 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14276 {
14277 for (bp_location *location : bpt->locations ())
14278 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14279 }
14280
14281 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14282
14283 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14284 }
14285
14286 /* Enable or disable the breakpoint(s) or breakpoint location(s)
14287 specified in ARGS. ARGS may be in any of the formats handled by
14288 extract_bp_number_and_location. ENABLE specifies whether to enable
14289 or disable the breakpoints/locations. */
14290
14291 static void
14292 enable_disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty, bool enable)
14293 {
14294 if (args == 0)
14295 {
14296 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
14297 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14298 {
14299 if (enable)
14300 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
14301 else
14302 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14303 }
14304 }
14305 else
14306 {
14307 std::string num = extract_arg (&args);
14308
14309 while (!num.empty ())
14310 {
14311 std::pair<int, int> bp_num_range, bp_loc_range;
14312
14313 extract_bp_number_and_location (num, bp_num_range, bp_loc_range);
14314
14315 if (bp_loc_range.first == bp_loc_range.second
14316 && bp_loc_range.first == 0)
14317 {
14318 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x' or 'x-z'. */
14319 map_breakpoint_number_range (bp_num_range,
14320 enable
14321 ? enable_breakpoint
14322 : disable_breakpoint);
14323 }
14324 else
14325 {
14326 /* Handle breakpoint ids with formats 'x.y' or
14327 'x.y-z'. */
14328 enable_disable_breakpoint_location_range
14329 (bp_num_range.first, bp_loc_range, enable);
14330 }
14331 num = extract_arg (&args);
14332 }
14333 }
14334 }
14335
14336 /* The disable command disables the specified breakpoints/locations
14337 (or all defined breakpoints) so they're no longer effective in
14338 stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the forms defined in
14339 extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14340
14341 static void
14342 disable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14343 {
14344 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, false);
14345 }
14346
14347 static void
14348 enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14349 int count)
14350 {
14351 int target_resources_ok;
14352
14353 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
14354 {
14355 int i;
14356 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
14357 target_resources_ok =
14358 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
14359 i + 1, 0);
14360 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
14361 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
14362 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
14363 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
14364 }
14365
14366 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
14367 {
14368 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
14369 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = bp_disabled;
14370
14371 try
14372 {
14373 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14374
14375 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
14376 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14377 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
14378 }
14379 catch (const gdb_exception &e)
14380 {
14381 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
14382 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
14383 bpt->number);
14384 return;
14385 }
14386 }
14387
14388 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
14389
14390 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14391 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14392
14393 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14394 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14395 {
14396 for (bp_location *location : bpt->locations ())
14397 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
14398 }
14399
14400 bpt->disposition = disposition;
14401 bpt->enable_count = count;
14402 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14403
14404 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (bpt);
14405 }
14406
14407
14408 void
14409 enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14410 {
14411 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
14412 }
14413
14414 /* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints/locations (or
14415 all defined breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to
14416 be) effective in stopping the inferior. ARGS may be in any of the
14417 forms defined in extract_bp_number_and_location. */
14418
14419 static void
14420 enable_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14421 {
14422 enable_disable_command (args, from_tty, true);
14423 }
14424
14425 static void
14426 enable_once_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14427 {
14428 map_breakpoint_numbers
14429 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14430 {
14431 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14432 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14433 {
14434 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, 1);
14435 });
14436 });
14437 }
14438
14439 static void
14440 enable_count_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14441 {
14442 int count;
14443
14444 if (args == NULL)
14445 error_no_arg (_("hit count"));
14446
14447 count = get_number (&args);
14448
14449 map_breakpoint_numbers
14450 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14451 {
14452 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14453 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14454 {
14455 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_disable, count);
14456 });
14457 });
14458 }
14459
14460 static void
14461 enable_delete_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14462 {
14463 map_breakpoint_numbers
14464 (args, [&] (breakpoint *b)
14465 {
14466 iterate_over_related_breakpoints
14467 (b, [&] (breakpoint *bpt)
14468 {
14469 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_del, 1);
14470 });
14471 });
14472 }
14473 \f
14474 /* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
14475 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
14476 GDB itself. */
14477
14478 static void
14479 invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
14480 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
14481 const bfd_byte *data)
14482 {
14483 for (breakpoint *bp : all_breakpoints ())
14484 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
14485 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
14486 {
14487 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
14488
14489 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val != nullptr)
14490 {
14491 for (bp_location *loc : bp->locations ())
14492 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
14493 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
14494 && addr + len > loc->address)
14495 {
14496 wp->val = NULL;
14497 wp->val_valid = false;
14498 }
14499 }
14500 }
14501 }
14502
14503 /* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
14504
14505 void
14506 insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14507 const address_space *aspace,
14508 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
14509 {
14510 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
14511 struct symtab_and_line sal;
14512 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
14513
14514 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
14515 {
14516 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
14517 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->global_num, gdbarch);
14518 }
14519
14520 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
14521 sal.pc = pc;
14522 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
14523 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
14524 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
14525
14526 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
14527 }
14528
14529 /* Insert single step breakpoints according to the current state. */
14530
14531 int
14532 insert_single_step_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
14533 {
14534 struct regcache *regcache = get_current_regcache ();
14535 std::vector<CORE_ADDR> next_pcs;
14536
14537 next_pcs = gdbarch_software_single_step (gdbarch, regcache);
14538
14539 if (!next_pcs.empty ())
14540 {
14541 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
14542 const address_space *aspace = get_frame_address_space (frame);
14543
14544 for (CORE_ADDR pc : next_pcs)
14545 insert_single_step_breakpoint (gdbarch, aspace, pc);
14546
14547 return 1;
14548 }
14549 else
14550 return 0;
14551 }
14552
14553 /* See breakpoint.h. */
14554
14555 int
14556 breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
14557 const address_space *aspace,
14558 CORE_ADDR pc)
14559 {
14560 for (bp_location *loc : bp->locations ())
14561 if (loc->inserted
14562 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
14563 return 1;
14564
14565 return 0;
14566 }
14567
14568 /* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
14569 PC. */
14570
14571 int
14572 single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (const address_space *aspace,
14573 CORE_ADDR pc)
14574 {
14575 for (breakpoint *bpt : all_breakpoints ())
14576 {
14577 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
14578 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
14579 return 1;
14580 }
14581 return 0;
14582 }
14583
14584 /* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
14585
14586 /* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
14587 static void
14588 set_tracepoint_count (int num)
14589 {
14590 tracepoint_count = num;
14591 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
14592 }
14593
14594 static void
14595 trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14596 {
14597 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14598 current_language);
14599 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops = breakpoint_ops_for_event_location
14600 (location.get (), true /* is_tracepoint */);
14601
14602 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14603 location.get (),
14604 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
14605 0 /* tempflag */,
14606 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14607 0 /* Ignore count */,
14608 pending_break_support,
14609 ops,
14610 from_tty,
14611 1 /* enabled */,
14612 0 /* internal */, 0);
14613 }
14614
14615 static void
14616 ftrace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14617 {
14618 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&arg,
14619 current_language);
14620 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14621 location.get (),
14622 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
14623 0 /* tempflag */,
14624 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14625 0 /* Ignore count */,
14626 pending_break_support,
14627 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14628 from_tty,
14629 1 /* enabled */,
14630 0 /* internal */, 0);
14631 }
14632
14633 /* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
14634
14635 static void
14636 strace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14637 {
14638 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
14639 event_location_up location;
14640
14641 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
14642 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
14643 if (arg && startswith (arg, "-m") && isspace (arg[2]))
14644 {
14645 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
14646 location = new_linespec_location (&arg, symbol_name_match_type::FULL);
14647 }
14648 else
14649 {
14650 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
14651 location = string_to_event_location (&arg, current_language);
14652 }
14653
14654 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14655 location.get (),
14656 NULL, 0, arg, false, 1 /* parse arg */,
14657 0 /* tempflag */,
14658 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
14659 0 /* Ignore count */,
14660 pending_break_support,
14661 ops,
14662 from_tty,
14663 1 /* enabled */,
14664 0 /* internal */, 0);
14665 }
14666
14667 /* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
14668 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
14669
14670 static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
14671 static int next_cmd;
14672
14673 static char *
14674 read_uploaded_action (void)
14675 {
14676 char *rslt = nullptr;
14677
14678 if (next_cmd < this_utp->cmd_strings.size ())
14679 {
14680 rslt = this_utp->cmd_strings[next_cmd].get ();
14681 next_cmd++;
14682 }
14683
14684 return rslt;
14685 }
14686
14687 /* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
14688 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
14689 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
14690 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
14691 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
14692
14693 struct tracepoint *
14694 create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
14695 {
14696 const char *addr_str;
14697 char small_buf[100];
14698 struct tracepoint *tp;
14699
14700 if (utp->at_string)
14701 addr_str = utp->at_string.get ();
14702 else
14703 {
14704 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
14705 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
14706 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
14707 user. */
14708 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
14709 "source location, using raw address"),
14710 utp->number);
14711 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
14712 addr_str = small_buf;
14713 }
14714
14715 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
14716 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
14717 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
14718 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
14719 utp->number);
14720
14721 event_location_up location = string_to_event_location (&addr_str,
14722 current_language);
14723 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
14724 location.get (),
14725 utp->cond_string.get (), -1, addr_str,
14726 false /* force_condition */,
14727 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
14728 0 /* tempflag */,
14729 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
14730 0 /* Ignore count */,
14731 pending_break_support,
14732 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
14733 0 /* from_tty */,
14734 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
14735 0 /* internal */,
14736 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
14737 return NULL;
14738
14739 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
14740 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
14741 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
14742
14743 if (utp->pass > 0)
14744 {
14745 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
14746 tp->number);
14747
14748 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
14749 }
14750
14751 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
14752 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
14753 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
14754 function. */
14755 if (!utp->cmd_strings.empty ())
14756 {
14757 counted_command_line cmd_list;
14758
14759 this_utp = utp;
14760 next_cmd = 0;
14761
14762 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL);
14763
14764 breakpoint_set_commands (tp, std::move (cmd_list));
14765 }
14766 else if (!utp->actions.empty ()
14767 || !utp->step_actions.empty ())
14768 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
14769 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
14770 utp->number);
14771
14772 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
14773 tp->hit_count = utp->hit_count;
14774 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
14775
14776 return tp;
14777 }
14778
14779 /* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
14780 omitted. */
14781
14782 static void
14783 info_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14784 {
14785 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14786 int num_printed;
14787
14788 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, false, is_tracepoint);
14789
14790 if (num_printed == 0)
14791 {
14792 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
14793 uiout->message ("No tracepoints.\n");
14794 else
14795 uiout->message ("No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
14796 }
14797
14798 default_collect_info ();
14799 }
14800
14801 /* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
14802 Not supported by all targets. */
14803 static void
14804 enable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14805 {
14806 enable_command (args, from_tty);
14807 }
14808
14809 /* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
14810 Not supported by all targets. */
14811 static void
14812 disable_trace_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14813 {
14814 disable_command (args, from_tty);
14815 }
14816
14817 /* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
14818 static void
14819 delete_trace_command (const char *arg, int from_tty)
14820 {
14821 dont_repeat ();
14822
14823 if (arg == 0)
14824 {
14825 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14826
14827 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
14828 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
14829 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
14830 argument. */
14831 for (breakpoint *tp : all_tracepoints ())
14832 if (is_tracepoint (tp) && user_breakpoint_p (tp))
14833 {
14834 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14835 break;
14836 }
14837
14838 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14839 if (!from_tty
14840 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
14841 {
14842 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints_safe ())
14843 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
14844 delete_breakpoint (b);
14845 }
14846 }
14847 else
14848 map_breakpoint_numbers
14849 (arg, [&] (breakpoint *br)
14850 {
14851 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (br, delete_breakpoint);
14852 });
14853 }
14854
14855 /* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
14856
14857 static void
14858 trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
14859 {
14860 tp->pass_count = count;
14861 gdb::observers::breakpoint_modified.notify (tp);
14862 if (from_tty)
14863 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
14864 tp->number, count);
14865 }
14866
14867 /* Set passcount for tracepoint.
14868
14869 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
14870 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
14871 Also accepts special argument "all". */
14872
14873 static void
14874 trace_pass_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
14875 {
14876 struct tracepoint *t1;
14877 ULONGEST count;
14878
14879 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
14880 error (_("passcount command requires an "
14881 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
14882
14883 count = strtoulst (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
14884
14885 args = skip_spaces (args);
14886 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
14887 {
14888 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
14889 if (*args)
14890 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
14891
14892 for (breakpoint *b : all_tracepoints ())
14893 {
14894 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14895 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14896 }
14897 }
14898 else if (*args == '\0')
14899 {
14900 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
14901 if (t1)
14902 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14903 }
14904 else
14905 {
14906 number_or_range_parser parser (args);
14907 while (!parser.finished ())
14908 {
14909 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &parser);
14910 if (t1)
14911 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
14912 }
14913 }
14914 }
14915
14916 struct tracepoint *
14917 get_tracepoint (int num)
14918 {
14919 for (breakpoint *t : all_tracepoints ())
14920 if (t->number == num)
14921 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14922
14923 return NULL;
14924 }
14925
14926 /* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
14927 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
14928 reconnecting). */
14929
14930 struct tracepoint *
14931 get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
14932 {
14933 for (breakpoint *b : all_tracepoints ())
14934 {
14935 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14936
14937 if (t->number_on_target == num)
14938 return t;
14939 }
14940
14941 return NULL;
14942 }
14943
14944 /* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
14945 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
14946 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
14947 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
14948
14949 struct tracepoint *
14950 get_tracepoint_by_number (const char **arg,
14951 number_or_range_parser *parser)
14952 {
14953 int tpnum;
14954 const char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
14955
14956 if (parser != NULL)
14957 {
14958 gdb_assert (!parser->finished ());
14959 tpnum = parser->get_number ();
14960 }
14961 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
14962 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
14963 else
14964 tpnum = get_number (arg);
14965
14966 if (tpnum <= 0)
14967 {
14968 if (instring && *instring)
14969 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
14970 instring);
14971 else
14972 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
14973 return NULL;
14974 }
14975
14976 for (breakpoint *t : all_tracepoints ())
14977 if (t->number == tpnum)
14978 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
14979
14980 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
14981 return NULL;
14982 }
14983
14984 void
14985 print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
14986 {
14987 if (b->thread != -1)
14988 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
14989
14990 if (b->task != 0)
14991 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
14992
14993 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
14994 }
14995
14996 /* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
14997 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
14998 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
14999 true. */
15000
15001 static void
15002 save_breakpoints (const char *filename, int from_tty,
15003 bool (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15004 {
15005 int any = 0;
15006 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15007
15008 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15009 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15010
15011 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15012 for (breakpoint *tp : all_breakpoints ())
15013 {
15014 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15015 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15016 continue;
15017
15018 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15019 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15020 continue;
15021
15022 any = 1;
15023
15024 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15025 {
15026 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15027
15028 /* We can stop searching. */
15029 break;
15030 }
15031 }
15032
15033 if (!any)
15034 {
15035 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15036 return;
15037 }
15038
15039 gdb::unique_xmalloc_ptr<char> expanded_filename (tilde_expand (filename));
15040
15041 stdio_file fp;
15042
15043 if (!fp.open (expanded_filename.get (), "w"))
15044 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15045 expanded_filename.get (), safe_strerror (errno));
15046
15047 if (extra_trace_bits)
15048 save_trace_state_variables (&fp);
15049
15050 for (breakpoint *tp : all_breakpoints ())
15051 {
15052 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15053 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15054 continue;
15055
15056 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15057 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15058 continue;
15059
15060 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, &fp);
15061
15062 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15063 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15064 instead. */
15065
15066 if (tp->cond_string)
15067 fp.printf (" condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15068
15069 if (tp->ignore_count)
15070 fp.printf (" ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15071
15072 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15073 {
15074 fp.puts (" commands\n");
15075
15076 current_uiout->redirect (&fp);
15077 try
15078 {
15079 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands.get (), 2);
15080 }
15081 catch (const gdb_exception &ex)
15082 {
15083 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15084 throw;
15085 }
15086
15087 current_uiout->redirect (NULL);
15088 fp.puts (" end\n");
15089 }
15090
15091 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15092 fp.puts ("disable $bpnum\n");
15093
15094 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15095 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15096 special, and not user visible. */
15097 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15098 {
15099 int n = 1;
15100
15101 for (bp_location *loc : tp->locations ())
15102 {
15103 if (!loc->enabled)
15104 fp.printf ("disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15105
15106 n++;
15107 }
15108 }
15109 }
15110
15111 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15112 fp.printf ("set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15113
15114 if (from_tty)
15115 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), expanded_filename.get ());
15116 }
15117
15118 /* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15119
15120 static void
15121 save_breakpoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15122 {
15123 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15124 }
15125
15126 /* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15127
15128 static void
15129 save_tracepoints_command (const char *args, int from_tty)
15130 {
15131 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15132 }
15133
15134 \f
15135 /* This help string is used to consolidate all the help string for specifying
15136 locations used by several commands. */
15137
15138 #define LOCATION_HELP_STRING \
15139 "Linespecs are colon-separated lists of location parameters, such as\n\
15140 source filename, function name, label name, and line number.\n\
15141 Example: To specify the start of a label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15142 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use\n\
15143 \"factorial.c:fact:the_top\".\n\
15144 \n\
15145 Address locations begin with \"*\" and specify an exact address in the\n\
15146 program. Example: To specify the fourth byte past the start function\n\
15147 \"main\", use \"*main + 4\".\n\
15148 \n\
15149 Explicit locations are similar to linespecs but use an option/argument\n\
15150 syntax to specify location parameters.\n\
15151 Example: To specify the start of the label named \"the_top\" in the\n\
15152 function \"fact\" in the file \"factorial.c\", use \"-source factorial.c\n\
15153 -function fact -label the_top\".\n\
15154 \n\
15155 By default, a specified function is matched against the program's\n\
15156 functions in all scopes. For C++, this means in all namespaces and\n\
15157 classes. For Ada, this means in all packages. E.g., in C++,\n\
15158 \"func()\" matches \"A::func()\", \"A::B::func()\", etc. The\n\
15159 \"-qualified\" flag overrides this behavior, making GDB interpret the\n\
15160 specified name as a complete fully-qualified name instead."
15161
15162 /* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15163 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15164 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15165 command. */
15166
15167 #define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15168 command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM]\n\
15169 \t[-force-condition] [if CONDITION]\n\
15170 PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15171 probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15172 guessed probe type), `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe) or \n\
15173 `-probe-dtrace' (for a DTrace probe).\n\
15174 LOCATION may be a linespec, address, or explicit location as described\n\
15175 below.\n\
15176 \n\
15177 With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15178 stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15179 \n\
15180 THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15181 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15182 \n\
15183 With the \"-force-condition\" flag, the condition is defined even when\n\
15184 it is invalid for all current locations.\n\
15185 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
15186 Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15187 conditions are different.\n\
15188 \n\
15189 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15190
15191 /* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15192 static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15193
15194 /* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15195 static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15196
15197 void
15198 add_catch_command (const char *name, const char *docstring,
15199 cmd_const_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15200 completer_ftype *completer,
15201 void *user_data_catch,
15202 void *user_data_tcatch)
15203 {
15204 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15205
15206 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15207 &catch_cmdlist);
15208 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15209 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15210 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15211
15212 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, docstring,
15213 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15214 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15215 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15216 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15217 }
15218
15219 /* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
15220 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
15221
15222 static int
15223 is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
15224 {
15225 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
15226 non-inline function. */
15227 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
15228 return 1;
15229
15230 return 0;
15231 }
15232
15233 /* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
15234 have been inlined. */
15235
15236 int
15237 pc_at_non_inline_function (const address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
15238 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
15239 {
15240 for (breakpoint *b : all_breakpoints ())
15241 {
15242 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
15243 continue;
15244
15245 for (bp_location *bl : b->locations ())
15246 {
15247 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
15248 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
15249 return 1;
15250 }
15251 }
15252
15253 return 0;
15254 }
15255
15256 /* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
15257
15258 void
15259 breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
15260 {
15261 for (bp_location *loc : all_bp_locations ())
15262 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
15263 loc->symtab = NULL;
15264 }
15265
15266 void
15267 initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
15268 {
15269 static int initialized = 0;
15270
15271 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15272
15273 if (initialized)
15274 return;
15275 initialized = 1;
15276
15277 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
15278 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
15279 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
15280 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15281 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15282 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15283 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
15284 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
15285 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
15286 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_create_sals_from_location;
15287 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
15288 ops->decode_location = bkpt_decode_location;
15289
15290 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
15291 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15292 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15293 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
15294 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15295 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15296 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15297 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
15298
15299 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
15300 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
15301 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15302 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
15303 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
15304 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
15305 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
15306 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
15307 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
15308 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
15309
15310 /* Internal breakpoints. */
15311 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
15312 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15313 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
15314 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
15315 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
15316 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
15317
15318 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
15319 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
15320 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15321 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
15322 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
15323 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
15324 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
15325
15326 /* Probe breakpoints. */
15327 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15328 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
15329 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
15330 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
15331 ops->create_sals_from_location = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15332 ops->decode_location = bkpt_probe_decode_location;
15333
15334 /* Watchpoints. */
15335 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15336 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15337 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
15338 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
15339 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
15340 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
15341 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
15342 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
15343 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
15344 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
15345 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
15346 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
15347 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
15348
15349 /* Masked watchpoints. */
15350 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15351 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
15352 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
15353 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
15354 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
15355 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
15356 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
15357 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
15358 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
15359 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
15360
15361 /* Tracepoints. */
15362 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15363 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15364 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
15365 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
15366 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
15367 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
15368 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
15369 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_create_sals_from_location;
15370 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
15371 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_decode_location;
15372
15373 /* Probe tracepoints. */
15374 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15375 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15376 ops->create_sals_from_location = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_location;
15377 ops->decode_location = tracepoint_probe_decode_location;
15378
15379 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
15380 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15381 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15382 ops->create_sals_from_location = strace_marker_create_sals_from_location;
15383 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
15384 ops->decode_location = strace_marker_decode_location;
15385
15386 /* Fork catchpoints. */
15387 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
15388 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15389 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
15390 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
15391 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
15392 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
15393 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
15394 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
15395 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
15396
15397 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
15398 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
15399 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15400 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
15401 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
15402 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
15403 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
15404 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
15405 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
15406 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
15407
15408 /* Exec catchpoints. */
15409 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
15410 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15411 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
15412 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
15413 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
15414 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
15415 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
15416 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
15417 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
15418
15419 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
15420 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
15421 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
15422 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
15423 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
15424 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
15425 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
15426 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
15427 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
15428 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
15429 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
15430
15431 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
15432 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
15433 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
15434 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
15435 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
15436 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
15437 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
15438 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
15439 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
15440 }
15441
15442 /* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
15443
15444 static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
15445
15446 /* See breakpoint.h. */
15447
15448 cmd_list_element *commands_cmd_element = nullptr;
15449
15450 void _initialize_breakpoint ();
15451 void
15452 _initialize_breakpoint ()
15453 {
15454 struct cmd_list_element *c;
15455
15456 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
15457
15458 gdb::observers::solib_unloaded.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib,
15459 "breakpoint");
15460 gdb::observers::free_objfile.attach (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile,
15461 "breakpoint");
15462 gdb::observers::memory_changed.attach (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change,
15463 "breakpoint");
15464
15465 breakpoint_chain = 0;
15466 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
15467 before a breakpoint is set. */
15468 breakpoint_count = 0;
15469
15470 tracepoint_count = 0;
15471
15472 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
15473 Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
15474 Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
15475
15476 commands_cmd_element = add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint,
15477 commands_command, _("\
15478 Set commands to be executed when the given breakpoints are hit.\n\
15479 Give a space-separated breakpoint list as argument after \"commands\".\n\
15480 A list element can be a breakpoint number (e.g. `5') or a range of numbers\n\
15481 (e.g. `5-7').\n\
15482 With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
15483 The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
15484 Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
15485 Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
15486 then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
15487
15488 const auto cc_opts = make_condition_command_options_def_group (nullptr);
15489 static std::string condition_command_help
15490 = gdb::option::build_help (_("\
15491 Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
15492 Usage is `condition [OPTION] N COND', where N is an integer and COND\n\
15493 is an expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached.\n\
15494 \n\
15495 Options:\n\
15496 %OPTIONS%"), cc_opts);
15497
15498 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command,
15499 condition_command_help.c_str ());
15500 set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, condition_completer);
15501
15502 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
15503 Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
15504 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15505 so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
15506 by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
15507 \n"
15508 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
15509 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15510
15511 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
15512 Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15513 Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
15514 some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
15515 \n"
15516 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
15517 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15518
15519 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
15520 Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
15521 Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
15522 so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
15523 \n"
15524 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
15525 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15526
15527 cmd_list_element *enable_cmd
15528 = add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15529 Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15530 Usage: enable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15531 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15532 With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
15533 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15534 With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
15535 &enablelist, 1, &cmdlist);
15536
15537 add_com_alias ("en", enable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15538
15539 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
15540 Enable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15541 Usage: enable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15542 Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
15543 This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
15544 May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\"."),
15545 &enablebreaklist, 1, &enablelist);
15546
15547 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15548 Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\
15549 Usage: enable breakpoints once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15550 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15551 &enablebreaklist);
15552
15553 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15554 Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\
15555 Usage: enable breakpoints delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15556 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15557 &enablebreaklist);
15558
15559 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15560 Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\
15561 Usage: enable breakpoints count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15562 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15563 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15564 &enablebreaklist);
15565
15566 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
15567 Enable some breakpoints and delete when hit.\n\
15568 Usage: enable delete BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15569 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
15570 &enablelist);
15571
15572 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
15573 Enable some breakpoints for one hit.\n\
15574 Usage: enable once BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15575 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
15576 &enablelist);
15577
15578 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
15579 Enable some breakpoints for COUNT hits.\n\
15580 Usage: enable count COUNT BREAKPOINTNUM...\n\
15581 If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
15582 the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
15583 &enablelist);
15584
15585 cmd_list_element *disable_cmd
15586 = add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15587 Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15588 Usage: disable [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15589 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15590 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15591 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
15592 &disablelist, 1, &cmdlist);
15593 add_com_alias ("dis", disable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15594 add_com_alias ("disa", disable_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15595
15596 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
15597 Disable all or some breakpoints.\n\
15598 Usage: disable breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15599 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15600 To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15601 A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
15602 This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
15603 &disablelist);
15604
15605 cmd_list_element *delete_cmd
15606 = add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15607 Delete all or some breakpoints.\n\
15608 Usage: delete [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15609 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15610 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15611 \n\
15612 Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects."),
15613 &deletelist, 1, &cmdlist);
15614 add_com_alias ("d", delete_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15615 add_com_alias ("del", delete_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15616
15617 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
15618 Delete all or some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
15619 Usage: delete breakpoints [BREAKPOINTNUM]...\n\
15620 Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
15621 To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
15622 This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
15623 &deletelist);
15624
15625 cmd_list_element *clear_cmd
15626 = add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
15627 Clear breakpoint at specified location.\n\
15628 Argument may be a linespec, explicit, or address location as described below.\n\
15629 \n\
15630 With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
15631 is executing in.\n"
15632 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
15633 See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
15634 add_com_alias ("cl", clear_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15635
15636 cmd_list_element *break_cmd
15637 = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
15638 Set breakpoint at specified location.\n"
15639 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
15640 set_cmd_completer (break_cmd, location_completer);
15641
15642 add_com_alias ("b", break_cmd, class_run, 1);
15643 add_com_alias ("br", break_cmd, class_run, 1);
15644 add_com_alias ("bre", break_cmd, class_run, 1);
15645 add_com_alias ("brea", break_cmd, class_run, 1);
15646
15647 if (dbx_commands)
15648 {
15649 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
15650 Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
15651 &stoplist, 1, &cmdlist);
15652 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
15653 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
15654 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
15655 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
15656 add_com ("status", class_info, info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15657 Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15658 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15659 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15660 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15661 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15662 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15663 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15664 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15665 \n\
15666 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15667 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15668 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15669 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15670 breakpoint set."));
15671 }
15672
15673 cmd_list_element *info_breakpoints_cmd
15674 = add_info ("breakpoints", info_breakpoints_command, _("\
15675 Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
15676 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15677 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15678 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15679 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15680 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15681 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15682 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15683 \n\
15684 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15685 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15686 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15687 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15688 breakpoint set."));
15689
15690 add_info_alias ("b", info_breakpoints_cmd, 1);
15691
15692 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
15693 Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
15694 The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
15695 \tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
15696 \twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
15697 \tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
15698 \tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
15699 \tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
15700 \tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
15701 The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
15702 the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
15703 breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
15704 address and file/line number respectively.\n\
15705 \n\
15706 Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
15707 are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
15708 is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
15709 Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
15710 breakpoint set."),
15711 &maintenanceinfolist);
15712
15713 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, _("\
15714 Set catchpoints to catch events."),
15715 &catch_cmdlist,
15716 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15717
15718 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, _("\
15719 Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
15720 &tcatch_cmdlist,
15721 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15722
15723 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
15724 catch_fork_command_1,
15725 NULL,
15726 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
15727 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
15728 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
15729 catch_fork_command_1,
15730 NULL,
15731 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
15732 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
15733 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
15734 catch_exec_command_1,
15735 NULL,
15736 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15737 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15738 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
15739 Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
15740 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15741 catch_load_command_1,
15742 NULL,
15743 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15744 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15745 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
15746 Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
15747 If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
15748 catch_unload_command_1,
15749 NULL,
15750 CATCH_PERMANENT,
15751 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
15752
15753 const auto opts = make_watch_options_def_group (nullptr);
15754
15755 static const std::string watch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\
15756 Set a watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\
15757 Usage: watch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15758 \n\
15759 Options:\n\
15760 %OPTIONS%\n\
15761 \n\
15762 A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15763 an expression changes."), opts);
15764 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command,
15765 watch_help.c_str ());
15766 set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer);
15767
15768 static const std::string rwatch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\
15769 Set a read watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\
15770 Usage: rwatch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15771 \n\
15772 Options:\n\
15773 %OPTIONS%\n\
15774 \n\
15775 A read watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
15776 an expression is read."), opts);
15777 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command,
15778 rwatch_help.c_str ());
15779 set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer);
15780
15781 static const std::string awatch_help = gdb::option::build_help (_("\
15782 Set an access watchpoint for EXPRESSION.\n\
15783 Usage: awatch [-location] EXPRESSION\n\
15784 \n\
15785 Options:\n\
15786 %OPTIONS%\n\
15787 \n\
15788 An access watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value\n\
15789 of an expression is either read or written."), opts);
15790 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command,
15791 awatch_help.c_str ());
15792 set_cmd_completer_handle_brkchars (c, watch_command_completer);
15793
15794 add_info ("watchpoints", info_watchpoints_command, _("\
15795 Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
15796
15797 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
15798 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
15799 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
15800 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
15801 Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15802 Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
15803 If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
15804 such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
15805 created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
15806 hardware.)"),
15807 NULL,
15808 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
15809 &setlist, &showlist);
15810
15811 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
15812
15813 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
15814
15815 cmd_list_element *trace_cmd
15816 = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
15817 Set a tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15818 \n"
15819 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
15820 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15821 set_cmd_completer (trace_cmd, location_completer);
15822
15823 add_com_alias ("tp", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 0);
15824 add_com_alias ("tr", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15825 add_com_alias ("tra", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15826 add_com_alias ("trac", trace_cmd, class_breakpoint, 1);
15827
15828 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
15829 Set a fast tracepoint at specified location.\n\
15830 \n"
15831 BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
15832 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15833 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15834
15835 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
15836 Set a static tracepoint at location or marker.\n\
15837 \n\
15838 strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
15839 LOCATION may be a linespec, explicit, or address location (described below) \n\
15840 or -m MARKER_ID.\n\n\
15841 If a marker id is specified, probe the marker with that name. With\n\
15842 no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected stack frame.\n\
15843 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
15844 This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
15845 tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
15846 by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
15847 \n\
15848 CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15849 \n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING "\n\n\
15850 Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15851 conditions are different.\n\
15852 \n\
15853 Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
15854 Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
15855 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
15856
15857 cmd_list_element *info_tracepoints_cmd
15858 = add_info ("tracepoints", info_tracepoints_command, _("\
15859 Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
15860 Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
15861 last tracepoint set."));
15862
15863 add_info_alias ("tp", info_tracepoints_cmd, 1);
15864
15865 cmd_list_element *delete_tracepoints_cmd
15866 = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
15867 Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
15868 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15869 No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
15870 &deletelist);
15871 add_alias_cmd ("tr", delete_tracepoints_cmd, class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
15872
15873 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
15874 Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
15875 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15876 No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
15877 &disablelist);
15878 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
15879
15880 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
15881 Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
15882 Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
15883 No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
15884 &enablelist);
15885 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
15886
15887 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
15888 Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
15889 The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
15890 Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
15891 if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
15892
15893 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint,
15894 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
15895 &save_cmdlist,
15896 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
15897
15898 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
15899 Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
15900 This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
15901 catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
15902 session to restore them."),
15903 &save_cmdlist);
15904 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
15905
15906 cmd_list_element *save_tracepoints_cmd
15907 = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
15908 Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
15909 Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
15910 &save_cmdlist);
15911 set_cmd_completer (save_tracepoints_cmd, filename_completer);
15912
15913 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", save_tracepoints_cmd, class_trace, 0);
15914 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
15915
15916 add_basic_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, _("\
15917 Breakpoint specific settings.\n\
15918 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15919 pending breakpoint behavior."),
15920 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15921 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
15922 add_show_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, _("\
15923 Breakpoint specific settings.\n\
15924 Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
15925 pending breakpoint behavior."),
15926 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist,
15927 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
15928
15929 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
15930 &pending_break_support, _("\
15931 Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15932 Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
15933 If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
15934 pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
15935 an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
15936 user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
15937 NULL,
15938 show_pending_break_support,
15939 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15940 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15941
15942 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
15943
15944 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
15945 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
15946 Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15947 Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
15948 If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
15949 breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
15950 a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
15951 NULL,
15952 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
15953 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15954 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15955
15956 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
15957 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
15958 Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15959 Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
15960 When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
15961 they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
15962 only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
15963 breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
15964 when execution stops."),
15965 NULL,
15966 &show_always_inserted_mode,
15967 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15968 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15969
15970 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
15971 condition_evaluation_enums,
15972 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
15973 Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15974 Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
15975 When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
15976 evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
15977 breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
15978 supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
15979 If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
15980 \"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
15981 be set to \"host\"."),
15982 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
15983 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
15984 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
15985 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
15986
15987 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
15988 Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
15989 break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
15990 where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
15991 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
15992 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
15993 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
15994 or the start of the range\n\
15995 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
15996 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
15997 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
15998 \n\
15999 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16000 an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16001 range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16002
16003 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16004 Set a dynamic printf at specified location.\n\
16005 dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16006 location may be a linespec, explicit, or address location.\n"
16007 "\n" LOCATION_HELP_STRING));
16008 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16009
16010 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16011 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16012 Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16013 Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16014 This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16015 If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16016 console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16017 If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16018 program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16019 output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16020 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16021 &setlist, &showlist);
16022
16023 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16024 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16025 &dprintf_function, _("\
16026 Set the function to use for dynamic printf."), _("\
16027 Show the function to use for dynamic printf."), NULL,
16028 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16029 &setlist, &showlist);
16030
16031 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16032 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16033 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16034 Set the channel to use for dynamic printf."), _("\
16035 Show the channel to use for dynamic printf."), NULL,
16036 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16037 &setlist, &showlist);
16038
16039 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16040 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16041 Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16042 Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16043 Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16044 even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16045 NULL,
16046 NULL,
16047 &setlist, &showlist);
16048
16049 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16050 Target agent only formatted printing, like the C \"printf\" function.\n\
16051 Usage: agent-printf \"format string\", ARG1, ARG2, ARG3, ..., ARGN\n\
16052 This supports most C printf format specifications, like %s, %d, etc.\n\
16053 This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16054
16055 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = true;
16056
16057 gdb::observers::about_to_proceed.attach (breakpoint_about_to_proceed,
16058 "breakpoint");
16059 gdb::observers::thread_exit.attach (remove_threaded_breakpoints,
16060 "breakpoint");
16061 }
This page took 0.36838 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.